blob: a6ff8df34ad41ec8b4e98b85a0e92901af6e3635 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-options
626 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-options
629 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100630 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200631 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100632 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100633 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100634 - 51degrees-data-file
635 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200636 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200637 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200638 - wurfl-data-file
639 - wurfl-information-list
640 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200641 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100642 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100645 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200646 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200648 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100649 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100650 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100651 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200652 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200653 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200654 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200655 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 - noepoll
657 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000658 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100660 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300661 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000662 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100663 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200664 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200665 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200666 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000667 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000668 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200669 - tune.buffers.limit
670 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200671 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200672 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100673 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200674 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200675 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200676 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100677 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200678 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200679 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100691 - tune.rcvbuf.client
692 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100693 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200694 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100695 - tune.sndbuf.client
696 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100697 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200699 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200701 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200702 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100703 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100705 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
707 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
708 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100709 - tune.zlib.memlevel
710 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712 * Debugging
713 - debug
714 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200715 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716
717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007183.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719------------------------------------
720
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200721ca-base <dir>
722 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100723 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
724 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
725 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727chroot <jail dir>
728 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
729 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
730 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
731 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
732 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100733 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100734
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100735cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
736 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
737 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
738 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
739 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
740 set. These sets have the format
741
742 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
743
744 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100746 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
747 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100748 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
749 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100751 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
755 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
756 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
757 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100758
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100759 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
760 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
761 on the machine's word size.
762
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100763 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
765 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
766 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
767 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
768 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
769 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770
771 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100772 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
773
774 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
775 # first 4 CPUs
776
777 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
778 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
779 # word size.
780
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100781 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
786
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100787 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
788 # and so on.
789 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100793 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100794 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
795 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
796 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
797
798 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
799 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
801
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100802 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
803 # and a thread range.
804 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
805 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
807
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808crt-base <dir>
809 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100810 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
811 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200813daemon
814 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
815 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100816 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
817 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200819deviceatlas-json-file <path>
820 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100821 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200822
823deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100824 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
826
827deviceatlas-separator <char>
828 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
829 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
830
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100831deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200832 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
833 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
834 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100835
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900836external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100837 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
838 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100839 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
840 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
841 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
842 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
843 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845gid <number>
846 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
847 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
848 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100849 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
850 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100852
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100853group <group name>
854 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
855 See also "gid" and "user".
856
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100857hard-stop-after <time>
858 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
859
860 Arguments :
861 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
862 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
863 SIGUSR1 signal.
864
865 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
866 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
867 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
868
869 Example:
870 global
871 hard-stop-after 30s
872
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200873h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
874 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
875 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
876 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
877 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500878 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
880 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
881 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
882 specified in a proxy.
883
884 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
885 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
886 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
887 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
888 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
889 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
890 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
891
892 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
893 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
894 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
895 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
896 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
897
898 Example:
899 global
900 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
901
902 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
903 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
904
905h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
906 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
907 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
908 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
909 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
910 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
911 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
912 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
913 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
914
915 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
916 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
917 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
918
919 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
920 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
921
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100922insecure-fork-wanted
923 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
924 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
925 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
926 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
927 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
928 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
929 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
930 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
931 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
932 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
933 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
934 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
935 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
936 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
937 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
938 disable it.
939
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100940insecure-setuid-wanted
941 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
942 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
943 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
944 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
945 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
946 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
947 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
948 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
949 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
950 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
951 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
952 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
953 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
954 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
955
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100956issuers-chain-path <dir>
957 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
958 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
959 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
960 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
961 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
962 "issuers-chain-path".
963 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
964 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
965 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
966 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
967 will share the chain in memory.
968
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200969log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
970 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100971 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100972 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100973 configured with "log global".
974
975 <address> can be one of:
976
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100977 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100978 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
979 port).
980
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100981 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
982 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
983 port).
984
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100985 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
987 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100990 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
991 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
992 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
993 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
994 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
995 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
996 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
997 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
998 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
999 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1000 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1001 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1002 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1003 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001004 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1005 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001006
1007 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1008 "fd@2", see above.
1009
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001010 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1011 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1012 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1013 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1014 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1015
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001016 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1017 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001018
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001019 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1020 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1021 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1022 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1023 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1024 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1025 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1026 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1027 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1028 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001029 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1030 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001031
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001032 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1033 one of the following :
1034
1035 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1036 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1037
1038 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1039 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1040
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001041 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1042 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1043 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1044 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1045 logger consumes.
1046
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001047 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1048 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1049 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1050 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1051
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001052 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1053 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1054 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1055 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1056 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1057
1058 <sample_size>
1059 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1060 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1061 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1062 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1063 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1064
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001065 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001067 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1068 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1069 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1070
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001071 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1072 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1073 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1074 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001075
1076 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001077 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1078 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1079 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1080 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1081 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1082 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001084 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001086log-send-hostname [<string>]
1087 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1088 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1089 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1090 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1091 the logs.
1092
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001093log-tag <string>
1094 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1095 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1096 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001097 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001098
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001099lua-load <file>
1100 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1101 used multiple times.
1102
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001103lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1104 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1105 variable.
1106 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1107 to "path".
1108
1109 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1110 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1111 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1112 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1113 will be checked earlier.
1114
1115 As an example by specifying the following path:
1116
1117 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1119
1120 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1121 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1123 paths if that does not exist either.
1124
1125 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1126 documentation.
1127
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001128master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001129 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1130 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1131 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001133 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1134 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001135 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1136 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1137 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1138 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1139 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001140
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001141 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001143mworker-max-reloads <number>
1144 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001145 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001146 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1147 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1148 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150nbproc <number>
1151 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1152 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1153 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001154 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1155 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001156 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1157 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001159nbthread <number>
1160 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001161 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1162 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1163 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1164 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1165 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001166 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1167 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1168 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1169 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1170 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1171 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1172 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001173
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001174pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001175 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1177 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1178
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001179presetenv <name> <value>
1180 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1181 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1182 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1183 and "unsetenv".
1184
1185resetenv [<name> ...]
1186 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1187 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1188 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1189 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1190 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1191 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1192 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1193 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1194
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001195stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001196 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1197 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1198 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1199 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1200 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1201 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001202 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001203 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1204 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1205 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1206 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001207
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001208server-state-base <directory>
1209 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001210 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1211 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001212
1213server-state-file <file>
1214 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1215 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1216 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1217 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1218 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1219 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1220 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1221 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001222 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1223 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001224
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001225setenv <name> <value>
1226 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1227 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1228 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1229 and "unsetenv".
1230
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001231set-dumpable
1232 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001233 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1234 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1235 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1236 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1237 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1238 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1239 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1240 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1241 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1242 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1243 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1244 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1245 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1246 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1247 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1248 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1249 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001250
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001251ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1253 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001254 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001256 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1257 information and recommendations see e.g.
1258 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1259 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1260 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1261 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001262
1263ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1265 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1266 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1267 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1268 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001269 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1270 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1271 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001272 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001273
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001274ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1276 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1277 keyword to see available options.
1278
1279 Example:
1280 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001281 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001283ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1285 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001286 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001287 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001288 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1289 information and recommendations see e.g.
1290 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1291 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1292 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1293 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1294 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295
1296ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1298 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1299 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1300 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1301 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001302 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1303 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1304 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1305 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001306
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001307ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1309 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1310 keyword to see available options.
1311
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001312ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1314 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1315 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001316 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001317 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001318 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1319 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1320 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1321 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001322 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1323 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1324 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1325
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001326ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001327 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1328 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1329
1330 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1331 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1332 optimize the startup time.
1333
1334 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1335 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1336 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1337
1338 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001339 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001340
1341 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1342 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1343 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1344 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1345 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1346 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001347 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1349
1350 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1351
1352 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1353
1354 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1355 not provided in the PEM file.
1356
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001357 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1358 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1359
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001360 The default behavior is "all".
1361
1362 Example:
1363 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1364 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1365 ssl-load-extra-files none
1366
1367 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1368
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001369ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1370 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1371 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1372 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1373
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001374ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1375 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1376 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1377 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1378 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1379 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1380 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1381 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1382 bits does not need it.
1383
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001384stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1385 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1386 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1387 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001388 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001389 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001390
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001391 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1392 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1393 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001394
1395stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1396 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1397 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001398 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001399
1400stats maxconn <connections>
1401 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1402 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1403
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001404uid <number>
1405 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1406 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1407 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1408 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1409
1410ulimit-n <number>
1411 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1412 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1413 option.
1414
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001415unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1416 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1417
1418 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1419 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1420 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1421 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1422 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1423 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1424 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1425 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1426 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1427 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1428
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001429unsetenv [<name> ...]
1430 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1431 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1432 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1433 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1434 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1435 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1436 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438user <user name>
1439 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1440 See also "uid" and "group".
1441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001442node <name>
1443 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1444
1445 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1446 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1447 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1448 traffic.
1449
1450description <text>
1451 Add a text that describes the instance.
1452
1453 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1454 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1455 "<" and ">" characters.
1456
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100145751degrees-data-file <file path>
1458 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001460
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001462 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1463
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000146451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001465 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1466 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1467 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200147251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1474 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1475
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001476 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1477 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1478
147951degrees-cache-size <number>
1480 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1481 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1482 By default, this cache is disabled.
1483
1484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001487wurfl-data-file <file path>
1488 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1489 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1490
1491 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1492 with USE_WURFL=1.
1493
1494wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1495 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1496 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1497 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1498
1499 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1500
1501 Valid WURFL properties are:
1502 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1503
1504 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1505 device.
1506
1507 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1508 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1509
1510 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1511 particular web request.
1512
1513 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1514 used Libwurfl API version.
1515
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001516 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1517 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1518
1519 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1520 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1521
1522 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1525 with USE_WURFL=1.
1526
1527wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1528 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1529 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1530
1531 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1532 with USE_WURFL=1.
1533
1534wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1535 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1536 thus before the chroot.
1537
1538 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1539 with USE_WURFL=1.
1540
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001541wurfl-cache-size <size>
1542 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1543 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001544 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001545 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001550strict-limits
1551 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1552 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1553 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1554 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1555 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1556 keyword.
1557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015583.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559-----------------------
1560
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001561busy-polling
1562 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1563 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1564 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1565 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1566 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1567 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1568 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1569 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1570 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1571 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1572 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1573 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1574 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1575 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1576 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1577 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1578 "poll" pollers.
1579
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001580 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1581 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1582 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1583
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001584max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1585 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1586 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1587 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1588 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1589 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1590 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1591 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1592 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001594maxconn <number>
1595 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1596 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1597 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001598 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1599 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1600 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1601 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001602 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1603 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1604 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1605 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1606 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1607 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001609maxconnrate <number>
1610 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1611 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1612 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1613 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1614 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1615 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1616 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1617 fairness.
1618
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001619maxcomprate <number>
1620 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001622 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1623 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1624 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001626 default value.
1627
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001628maxcompcpuusage <number>
1629 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1630 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1631 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1632 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1633 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1634 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1635 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1636 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1637
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001638maxpipes <number>
1639 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1640 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1641 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1642 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1643 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1644 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1645
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001646maxsessrate <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1648 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1649 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1650 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1651 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1652 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1653 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1654 fairness.
1655
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001656maxsslconn <number>
1657 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1658 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1659 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1660 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1661 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1662 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1663 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001664 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1665 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1666 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1667 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1668 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1669 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1670 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001671
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001672maxsslrate <number>
1673 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1674 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1675 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1676 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1677 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1678 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1679 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1680 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1681 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1682 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1683
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001684maxzlibmem <number>
1685 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1686 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1687 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001688 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1689 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1690 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692noepoll
1693 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1694 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001695 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
1697nokqueue
1698 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1699 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1700 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1701
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001702noevports
1703 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1704 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1705 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1706 also "nopoll".
1707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708nopoll
1709 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1710 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001711 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001712 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1713 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001715nosplice
1716 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001717 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001718 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001720 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1721 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1722 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1723 "option splice-response".
1724
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001725nogetaddrinfo
1726 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1727 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1728
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001729noreuseport
1730 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1731 command line argument "-dR".
1732
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001733profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1734 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1735 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1736 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1737 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001738 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001739 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1740 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1741 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1742 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1743
1744 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1745 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1746 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1747 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1748 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001749 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1750 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1751 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1752 CLI.
1753
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001754spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001755 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1756 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1757 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1758 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1759 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1760 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001763 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001764 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001765 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1766 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1767 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1768 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1769 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1771 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1773 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1774 openssl configuration file uses:
1775 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1776
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001777ssl-mode-async
1778 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001779 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001780 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1781 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1782 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001783 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001784 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001786tune.buffers.limit <number>
1787 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1788 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1789 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1790 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1791 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001792 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001793 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1794 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1795 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1796 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1797 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1798 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1799 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1800 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1801 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1802
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001803tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1804 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1805 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1806 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1807 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1808
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001809tune.bufsize <number>
1810 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1811 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1812 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1813 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1814 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1815 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1816 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001817 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1818 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1819 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001820 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001821 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1822 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1823 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001824
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001825tune.chksize <number>
1826 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1827 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1828 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1829 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1830 checks whenever possible.
1831
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001832tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1833 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1834 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1835 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1836 this value. The default value is 1.
1837
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001838tune.fail-alloc
1839 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1840 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1841 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1842 gracefully.
1843
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001844tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1845 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1846 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1847 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1848 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1849 change it.
1850
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001851tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1852 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1854 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001855 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1856 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1857 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1858 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1859 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1860
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001861tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1862 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1863 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1864 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1865 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1866 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1867 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1868 recommended not to change this value.
1869
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001870tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1872 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1873 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1874 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1875 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1876 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1877 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001879tune.http.cookielen <number>
1880 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1881 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1882 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1883 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1884 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1885 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1886 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1887 to change this value.
1888
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001889tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001890 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1891 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001892 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001893 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001894 configuration directives too.
1895 The default value is 1024.
1896
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001897tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1898 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1899 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1900 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1901 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1902 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1903 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001904 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1905 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1906 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001907
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001908tune.idletimer <timeout>
1909 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1910 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1911 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1912 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1913 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1914 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001915 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001916 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1918
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001919tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1920 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1921 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1922 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1923 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1924 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1925 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1926 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1927 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1928 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1929
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001930tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1931 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001932 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001933 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1934 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001935 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001936 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1937 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1938
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001939tune.lua.maxmem
1940 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1941 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1942 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1943 memory.
1944
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1946 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001947 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1948 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001950
1951tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1952 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1953 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1954 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1955 check servers.
1956
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001957tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1958 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1959 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1960 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001961 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001962
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001963tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001964 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1965 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1966 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1967 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1968 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1969 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1970 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1971 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1972 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1973 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001974
1975tune.maxpollevents <number>
1976 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1977 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1978 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1979 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1980 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1981
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001982tune.maxrewrite <number>
1983 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1984 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1985 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1986 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1987 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1988 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1989 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1990 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1991 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1992 bufsize.
1993
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001994tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1995 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1996 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1997 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1998 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1999 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2000 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2001 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2002 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2003 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002004 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2005 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002006 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2007 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2008 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2009 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2010 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2011 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2012 setting this parameter to 0.
2013
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002014tune.pipesize <number>
2015 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2016 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2017 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2018 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2019 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2020 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2021
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002022tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2023 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2024 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2025 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2026 default is 20.
2027
2028tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2029 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2030 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2031 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2032 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2033 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2034 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002035 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002036
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002037tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2038tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2039 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2040 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2041 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002042 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002043 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002044 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2045 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2046
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002047tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002048 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002049 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2050 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2051 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2052 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2053
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002054tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002055 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002056 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2057 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2058
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002059tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2060tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2061 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2062 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2063 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002065 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002066 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2067 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2068 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2069 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2070 notifying haproxy again.
2071
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002072tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002073 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2074 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2075 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002076 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002077 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002078 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002079 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2080 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2081 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002082 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2083 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002084
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002085tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002086 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002087 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2088 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2089 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2090 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2091 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2092
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002093tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2094 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002095 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002096 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2097 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2098 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2099 being used for too long.
2100
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002101tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2102 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2103 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2104 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2105 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2106 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2107 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2108 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2109 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2110 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2111 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002112 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002113 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002114
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002115tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2116 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2117 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2118 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2119 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2120 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2121 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2122 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002123 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2124 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002125
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002126tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2127 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2128 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2129 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2130 1000 entries.
2131
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002132tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2133 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2134 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2135 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2136
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002137tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002138tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002139tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2140tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2141tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002142 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2143 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2144 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2145 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2146 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2147 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2148 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2149 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002150
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002151 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2152 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2153 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2154 all available space is consumed.
2155 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2156 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2157 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002159tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2160 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002161 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002162 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002163 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002164 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2165
2166tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2167 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2168 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002169 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2170 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021723.3. Debugging
2173--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002175debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002176 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2177 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2178 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2179 system startup.
2180
2181quiet
2182 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2183 line argument "-q".
2184
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002185zero-warning
2186 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2187 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2188 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2189 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2190 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2191 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2192
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021943.4. Userlists
2195--------------
2196It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2197http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2198it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2199
2200userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002201 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002202 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2203
2204group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002205 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2207 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2208
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002209user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2210 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2212 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002213 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2214 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2215 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2216 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002217
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002218 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2219 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2220 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2221 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2222 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2223 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2224 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2225 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2226 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002227
2228 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002229 userlist L1
2230 group G1 users tiger,scott
2231 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002232
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002233 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2234 user scott insecure-password elgato
2235 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L2
2238 group G1
2239 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
2245 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002246
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002247
22483.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002249----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002250It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2251several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2252instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2253values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2254automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2255In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2256using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2257tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2258reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2259Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2260that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2261each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002262
2263peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002264 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002265 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2266
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002267bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2268 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2269 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2270
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002271disabled
2272 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2273 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2274 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276default-bind [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2278
2279default-server [param*]
2280 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2281
2282 Arguments:
2283 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2284 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2285 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2286 details.
2287
2288
2289 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2290
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002291enable
2292 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2293
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002294log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2295 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2296 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2297 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2298 more details.
2299
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002300peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002301 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2302 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2303 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2304 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2305 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2306 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2307
2308 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2309 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2310
2311 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2312 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2313 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2314 across all peers.
2315
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002316 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2317 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002318
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002319 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2320 "server" keyword explanation below).
2321
2322server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002323 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002324 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2325 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2326 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2327 of this "peers" section).
2328 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2329
2330
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002331 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002333 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002334 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2335 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2336 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002337
2338 backend mybackend
2339 mode tcp
2340 balance roundrobin
2341 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2342 stick on src
2343
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002344 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2345 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002347 Example:
2348 peers mypeers
2349 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2350 default-server ssl verify none
2351 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2352 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002353
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002354
2355table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2356 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2357
2358 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2359 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002360 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002361 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2362 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2363 "stick-table" keyword).
2364
2365 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2366 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2367 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2368 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2369 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2370 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2371 of the stick-table name as follows:
2372
2373 peers mypeers
2374 peer A ...
2375 peer B ...
2376 table t1 ...
2377
2378 frontend fe1
2379 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2380
2381 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2382 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2383
2384 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2385 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2386 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2387 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2388 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2389 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2390 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2391
2392 peers mypeers
2393 peer A ...
2394 peer B ...
2395 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2396
2397 backend t1
2398 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2399
2400 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2401 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2402 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2403
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024043.6. Mailers
2405------------
2406It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2407If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2408in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2409
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002410mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002411 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2412 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2413
2414mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2415 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2416
2417 Example:
2418 mailers mymailers
2419 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2420 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2421
2422 backend mybackend
2423 mode tcp
2424 balance roundrobin
2425
2426 email-alert mailers mymailers
2427 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2428 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2429
2430 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2431 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2432
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002433timeout mail <time>
2434 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2435 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2436 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2437 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2438
2439 Example:
2440 mailers mymailers
2441 timeout mail 20s
2442 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002443
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024443.7. Programs
2445-------------
2446In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2447master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2448managed the same way as the workers.
2449
2450During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2451sequence as a worker:
2452
2453 - the master is re-executed
2454 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2455 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2456 instance of the program
2457
2458During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2459
2460program <name>
2461 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2462 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2463 the management guide).
2464
2465command <command> [arguments*]
2466 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2467 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2468 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2469 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2470
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002471user <user name>
2472 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2473 See also "group".
2474
2475group <group name>
2476 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2477 See also "user".
2478
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002479option start-on-reload
2480no option start-on-reload
2481 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2482 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2483 program section.
2484
2485
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024863.8. HTTP-errors
2487----------------
2488
2489It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2490imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2491several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2492
2493http-errors <name>
2494 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2495 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2496
2497errorfile <code> <file>
2498 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2499
2500 Arguments :
2501 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2502 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2503 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2504
2505 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2506 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2507 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2508 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2509 before any chroot is performed.
2510
2511 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2512
2513 Example:
2514 http-errors website-1
2515 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2516 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2517 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2518
2519 http-errors website-2
2520 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2521 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2522 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2523
2524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025254. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002526----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002528Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002529 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002530 - frontend <name>
2531 - backend <name>
2532 - listen <name>
2533
2534A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2535its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2536section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538
2539A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2540connections.
2541
2542A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2543to forward incoming connections.
2544
2545A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2546parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2549'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2550case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2551
2552Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2553logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2554proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2555However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2556name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2557
2558Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2559and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002560bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2562modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2563arbitrary criteria.
2564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002565In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2566a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002567the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002568
2569 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2570 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2571 between responses and new requests.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2574 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2575 client-facing connection remains open.
2576
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002577 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2578 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002579
2580The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2581frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2582following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002583weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002586
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002587 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2588 ----+-----+-----+----
2589 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2590 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2592 ----+-----+-----+----
2593 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025974.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2598--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002600The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2601limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2602they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2603limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002604marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002605option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002606and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2607with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2608specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002610
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002611 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2612------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2613acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002614backlog X X X -
2615balance X - X X
2616bind - X X -
2617bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002618capture cookie - X X -
2619capture request header - X X -
2620capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002621compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002623declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624default-server X - X X
2625default_backend X X X -
2626description - X X X
2627disabled X X X X
2628dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002629email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002630email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002631email-alert mailers X X X X
2632email-alert myhostname X X X X
2633email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002634enabled X X X X
2635errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002636errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002637errorloc X X X X
2638errorloc302 X X X X
2639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2640errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002641force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002642filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643fullconn X - X X
2644grace X X X X
2645hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002646http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002647http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002648http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002649http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002650http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002651http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002652http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002653http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002654id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002655ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002656load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002657log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002658log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002659log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002660log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002661max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662maxconn X X X -
2663mode X X X X
2664monitor fail - X X -
2665monitor-net X X X -
2666monitor-uri X X X -
2667option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2668option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2669option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2670option allbackups (*) X - X X
2671option checkcache (*) X - X X
2672option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2673option contstats (*) X X X -
2674option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2675option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2677option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002678option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2679option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002680option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002681option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002682option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002683option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002684option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002685option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2686option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2687option httpchk X - X X
2688option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002689option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002690option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002691option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002692option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002693option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002694option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2695option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2696option logasap (*) X X X -
2697option mysql-check X - X X
2698option nolinger (*) X X X X
2699option originalto X X X X
2700option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002701option pgsql-check X - X X
2702option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002704option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002705option smtpchk X - X X
2706option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2707option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2708option splice-request (*) X X X X
2709option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002710option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2712option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2713-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002714option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002715option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2716option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2717option tcpka X X X X
2718option tcplog X X X X
2719option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002720external-check command X - X X
2721external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002722persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2723rate-limit sessions X X X -
2724redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002725-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002726retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002727retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002728server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002729server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002730server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002732stats admin - X X X
2733stats auth X X X X
2734stats enable X X X X
2735stats hide-version X X X X
2736stats http-request - X X X
2737stats realm X X X X
2738stats refresh X X X X
2739stats scope X X X X
2740stats show-desc X X X X
2741stats show-legends X X X X
2742stats show-node X X X X
2743stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002744-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2745stick match - - X X
2746stick on - - X X
2747stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002748stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002749stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002750tcp-check connect - - X X
2751tcp-check expect - - X X
2752tcp-check send - - X X
2753tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002754tcp-request connection - X X -
2755tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002756tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002757tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002758tcp-response content - - X X
2759tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002760timeout check X - X X
2761timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002762timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002763timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002764timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2765timeout http-request X X X X
2766timeout queue X - X X
2767timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002768timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002769timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002770timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002772unique-id-format X X X -
2773unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002775use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002776use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2778 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027814.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2782---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783
2784This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2785
2786
2787acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2788 Declare or complete an access list.
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 no | yes | yes | yes
2791 Example:
2792 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2793 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2794 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002796 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
2798
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002799backlog <conns>
2800 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | yes | yes | no
2803 Arguments :
2804 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2805 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002806 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002807
2808 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2809 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2810 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2811 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2812 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2813 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2814 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2815 backlog parameter.
2816
2817 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2818 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2819 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2820
2821 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2822
2823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002825balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | no | yes | yes
2829 Arguments :
2830 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2831 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2832 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2833 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2834
2835 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2836 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2837 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2838 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002839 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002840 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002841 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2842 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2843 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2844 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2845 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2846 it, so that you don't worry.
2847
2848 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2849 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2850 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2851 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2852 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2853 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2854 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2855 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002857 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2858 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2859 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2860 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2861 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2862 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2863 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2864 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2865
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002866 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002867 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002868 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2869 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002870 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002871 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2872 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2873 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2874 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2875 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002876 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2877 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2878 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2879 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2880 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2881 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002883 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2884 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2885 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2886 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2887 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2888 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2889 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2890 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002891 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002892 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002893 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2894 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2895 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002897 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2898 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2899 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2900 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2901 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2902 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2903 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2904 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2905 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002910 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002911 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2912 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2913 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2914 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2915 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2916 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2917 URIs start with a leading "/".
2918
2919 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2920 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2921 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2922 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002925 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2926
2927 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002928 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2929 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002930 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2931 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2932 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2933 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002934 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002935 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2936 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002937
2938 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2939 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2940 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2941 server will receive the request.
2942
2943 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2944 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2945 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2946 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2947 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002948 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2949 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2950 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002952 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2953 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2954 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2955 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2956 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002958 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002959 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2960 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2961 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2962
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002963 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2964 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2965 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2966
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002967 random
2968 random(<draws>)
2969 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002970 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2971 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2972 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2973 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002974 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2975 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2976 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2977 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2978 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2979 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2980 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2981 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2982 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2983 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2984 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2985 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2986 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2987 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2988 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2989 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2990 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2991 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2992 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2993 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002994
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002995 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002996 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002997 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2998 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2999 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3000 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3001 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3002 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003003 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003004 used instead.
3005
3006 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3007 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3008 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3009 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3010
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003011 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3012 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3013 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3014
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003015 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003017 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003018 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3019 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003020
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003021 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3022 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3023 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003025 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003026 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003027 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3028 NTLM relies on.
3029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030 Examples :
3031 balance roundrobin
3032 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003033 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003034 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3035 balance hdr(host)
3036 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003037
3038 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3039 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003041 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003042 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3043 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3044 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003045 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003046
3047 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3048 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3049 defaults to 16 kB.
3050
3051 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3052 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3053
3054 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3055 Round Robin.
3056
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003057 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003058 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3059 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3060 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3061
3062 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3063
3064 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003065 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003066 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3067 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3068 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003070 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071
3072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003073bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3074bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 no | yes | yes | no
3078 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003079 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3080 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3081 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3082 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003083 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003084 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3085 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3086 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3087 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3088 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3089 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3090 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003091 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3092 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3093 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3094 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3095 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3096 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3097 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003098 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3099 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3100 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003101 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3102 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3103 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3104 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003105 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3106 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3107 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003108
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003109 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3110 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003111 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3112 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3113 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003114 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3115 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3116 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3117 the range.
3118
3119 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3120 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3121 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3122 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3123 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3124 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3125 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003126 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003127 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003129 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003130 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003131 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3132 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3133 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3134 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3135 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3136 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3137
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003138 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3139 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3140 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3141 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003142
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3144 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3145 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3146 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3147 in a frontend.
3148
3149 Example :
3150 listen http_proxy
3151 bind :80,:443
3152 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003153 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003154
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003155 listen http_https_proxy
3156 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003157 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003158
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003159 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3160 bind ipv6@:80
3161 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3162 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3163
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003164 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003165 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003166
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003167 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3168 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3169 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3170 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3171 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3172
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003173 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003174 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
3176
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003177bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003178 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 yes | yes | yes | yes
3181 Arguments :
3182 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3183 may be used to override a default value.
3184
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003185 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003186 option may be combined with other numbers.
3187
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003188 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3190 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3191 missing from all processes.
3192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003193 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003194 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003195 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3196 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3197 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3198 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3199 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003200 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003201
3202 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3203 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3204 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3205 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3206 and 'even' instances.
3207
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003208 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3209 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3210 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3211 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003212
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003213 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3214 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3215
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003216 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3217 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3218 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3219
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003220 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3221 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3222
3223 Example :
3224 listen app_ip1
3225 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003226 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003227
3228 listen app_ip2
3229 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003230 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003231
3232 listen management
3233 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003234 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003235
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003236 listen management
3237 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3238 bind-process 1-4
3239
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003240 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003241
3242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243capture cookie <name> len <length>
3244 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3246 no | yes | yes | no
3247 Arguments :
3248 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3249 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3250 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3251 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003252 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253
3254 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3255 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3256 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3257 right if it exceeds <length>.
3258
3259 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3260 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3261 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3262 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3263
3264 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3265 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3266 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3267
3268 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3269 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3270 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003271 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3272 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3273 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274
3275 Example:
3276 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3277
3278 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003279 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
3281
3282capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003283 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3285 no | yes | yes | no
3286 Arguments :
3287 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003288 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3290 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3291 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3292
3293 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3294 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3295 it exceeds <length>.
3296
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003297 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3299 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003300 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3301 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3302 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3303 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003304 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003305 environments to find where the request came from.
3306
3307 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3308 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3309 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3310 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003312 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3313 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3314 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3315 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3316 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
3318 Example:
3319 capture request header Host len 15
3320 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003321 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003323 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 about logging.
3325
3326
3327capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003328 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3330 no | yes | yes | no
3331 Arguments :
3332 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003333 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003334 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3335 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3336 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3337
3338 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3339 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3340 it exceeds <length>.
3341
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003342 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3344 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3345 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003346 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3347 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3348 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3349 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003351 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3352 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3353 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3354 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3355 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003356
3357 Example:
3358 capture response header Content-length len 9
3359 capture response header Location len 15
3360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003361 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 about logging.
3363
3364
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003365compression algo <algorithm> ...
3366compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003367compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003368 Enable HTTP compression.
3369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3370 yes | yes | yes | yes
3371 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003372 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3373 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3374 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3375
3376 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003377 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3378 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3379 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003380
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003381 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003382 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003383
3384 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3385 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3386 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3387 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3388 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003389 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003390
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3392 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3393 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3394 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3395 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3396 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3397 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003398 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003399
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003400 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003401 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003402 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3403 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3404 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3405 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3406 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003407
3408 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3409 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3410 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3411 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3412 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003413 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3414 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3415 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3416 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3417 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003418 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3419 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003420
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003421 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003422 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3423 "Accept-Encoding" header
3424 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003425 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003426 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3427 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3428 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3429 "multipart"
3430 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3431 header
3432 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3433 and later
3434 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3435 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003436 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003437
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003438 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003439
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003440 Examples :
3441 compression algo gzip
3442 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003444
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003445cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003446 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3447 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003448 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | no | yes | yes
3452 Arguments :
3453 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3454 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3455 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3456 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3457 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3458 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003459 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3461 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3462
3463 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3464 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3465 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3466 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3467 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3468 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003469 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3470 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003471 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003472 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3473 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
3475 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003476 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003477
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003478 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003479 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003480 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003482 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3483 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3484 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3485 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3486 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3487 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3488 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489
3490 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3491 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3492 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3493 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3494 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3495 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3496 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3497 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3498 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003499 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003500 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3501 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3502 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003504 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3505 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3506 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003507 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3508 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3509 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3510 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003511 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3512 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3513 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
3515 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3516 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3517 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3518 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3519 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3520 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3521 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3522 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3523 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3524
3525 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3526 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3527 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3528 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3529 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3530 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3531 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3532 persistence cookie in the cache.
3533 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3534
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003535 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3536 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3537 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3538 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3539 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003540 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003541 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3542 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3543 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3544 they logout.
3545
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003546 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3547 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3548 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3549 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3550
3551 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3552 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3553 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3554 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3555 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3556 this attribute.
3557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003558 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003559 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003560 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3561 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3562 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3563 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3564 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3565 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003566
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003567 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3568 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3569 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3570 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3571 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3572 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3573 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3574 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003575 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003576 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3577 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3578 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3579 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3580 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3581 the site.
3582
3583 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3584 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3585 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3586 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3587 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3588 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3589 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3590 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3591 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3592 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3593 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3594 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3595 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003596 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003597 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3598 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3599
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003600 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3601 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3602 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3603 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3604 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3605 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3606
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003607 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3608 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3609 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3610 repeated.
3611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3613 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3614 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3615 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 Examples :
3618 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3619 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3620 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003621 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003623 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003624
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003625
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003626declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3627 Declares a capture slot.
3628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 no | yes | yes | no
3630 Arguments:
3631 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3632
3633 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3634 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3635 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3636 for use in the response.
3637
3638 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003639 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003640 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3641
3642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003643default-server [param*]
3644 Change default options for a server in a backend
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | no | yes | yes
3647 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003648 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3649 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3650 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3651 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003652
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003653 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003654 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3655
3656 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003659default_backend <backend>
3660 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | yes | yes | no
3663 Arguments :
3664 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3665
3666 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3667 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3668 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3669 will catch all undetermined requests.
3670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671 Example :
3672
3673 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3674 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3675 default_backend dynamic
3676
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003677 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003680description <string>
3681 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3683 no | yes | yes | yes
3684 Arguments : string
3685
3686 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3687 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3688 it describes.
3689 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3690
3691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692disabled
3693 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3695 yes | yes | yes | yes
3696 Arguments : none
3697
3698 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3699 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3700 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3701 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3702 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3703 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3704 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3705
3706 See also : "enabled"
3707
3708
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003709dispatch <address>:<port>
3710 Set a default server address
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003714
3715 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3716 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3717 during start-up.
3718
3719 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3720 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3721 possible with normal servers.
3722
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003723 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003724 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3725 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3726 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3727 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3728
3729 See also : "server"
3730
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003731
3732dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3733 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | no | yes | yes
3736 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3737
3738 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003740 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3741 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003742 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003743 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003745enabled
3746 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3748 yes | yes | yes | yes
3749 Arguments : none
3750
3751 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3752 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3753
3754 See also : "disabled"
3755
3756
3757errorfile <code> <file>
3758 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 yes | yes | yes | yes
3761 Arguments :
3762 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003763 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3764 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003765
3766 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003767 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003768 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003769 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3770 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771
3772 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3773 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3774 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3775
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003776 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003778 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3779 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3780 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3781 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3782
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003783 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3784 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003785 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003786 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3787 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3788 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3791 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3792 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003793 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3795
3796 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3797
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003798 Example :
3799 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003800 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003801 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3802 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003805errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3806 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3807 section.
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | yes | yes | yes
3810 Arguments :
3811 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3812
3813 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3814 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3815 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3816
3817 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3818 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3819 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3820 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3821 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3822 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3823 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3824
3825 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3826 3.8 about http-errors.
3827
3828 Example :
3829 errorfiles generic
3830 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3831
3832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833errorloc <code> <url>
3834errorloc302 <code> <url>
3835 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | yes | yes | yes
3838 Arguments :
3839 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003840 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3841 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842
3843 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3844 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3845 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3846 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003847 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003848
3849 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3850 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3851 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3852
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003853 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3854
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003855 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3856 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3857 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3858 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003859 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003860 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3861 request.
3862
3863 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3864
3865
3866errorloc303 <code> <url>
3867 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | yes | yes | yes
3870 Arguments :
3871 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003872 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3873 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003874
3875 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3876 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3877 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3878 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003879 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003880
3881 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3882 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3883 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3884
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003885 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3886
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003887 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3888 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3889 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3890 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003891 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892
3893 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3894
3895
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003896email-alert from <emailaddr>
3897 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003898 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | yes | yes | yes
3901
3902 Arguments :
3903
3904 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3905
3906 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3907 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3908
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003909 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003910 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3911 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003912
3913
3914email-alert level <level>
3915 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3916 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | yes | yes | yes
3919
3920 Arguments :
3921
3922 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3923 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3924 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3925
3926 By default level is alert
3927
3928 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3929 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3930 for the proxy.
3931
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003932 Alerts are sent when :
3933
3934 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3935 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3936 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3937 is notice or lower
3938 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3939 and a health check status update occurs
3940
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003941 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3942 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003943 section 3.6 about mailers.
3944
3945
3946email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3947 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | yes | yes | yes
3950
3951 Arguments :
3952
3953 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3954
3955 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3956 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3957
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003958 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3959 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003960
3961
3962email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3963 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3964 mailers.
3965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | yes
3967
3968 Arguments :
3969
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003970 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003971
3972 By default the systems hostname is used.
3973
3974 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3975 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3976 for the proxy.
3977
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003978 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3979 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003980
3981
3982email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003983 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003984 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | yes
3987
3988 Arguments :
3989
3990 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3991
3992 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3993 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3994
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003995 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003996 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3997
3998
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003999force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4000 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004002 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004003
4004 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4005 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4006 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4007 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4008 marked down for maintenance operations.
4009
4010 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4011 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4012 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4013 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4014 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4015 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4016 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4017 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4018 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4019
4020 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4021 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4022 is used.
4023
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004024 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004025 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004026
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004027
4028filter <name> [param*]
4029 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 no | yes | yes | yes
4032 Arguments :
4033 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4034 referenced in section 9.
4035
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004036 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004037 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004038 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4039 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004040
4041 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4042 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4043
4044 Example:
4045 listen
4046 bind *:80
4047
4048 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4049 filter compression
4050 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4051
4052 compression algo gzip
4053 compression offload
4054
4055 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4056
4057 See also : section 9.
4058
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004059
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004060fullconn <conns>
4061 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | no | yes | yes
4064 Arguments :
4065 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4066 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4067
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004068 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004069 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004070 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004071 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4072 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4073 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4074 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4075 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004076 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004078 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4079 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004080 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4081 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4082 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004083
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004084 Example :
4085 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4086 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4087 # connections.
4088 backend dynamic
4089 fullconn 10000
4090 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4091 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4092
4093 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4094
4095
4096grace <time>
4097 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100 Arguments :
4101 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4102 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4103 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4104
4105 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4106 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004107 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004108 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4109
4110 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4111 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4112 simplify it.
4113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004115hash-balance-factor <factor>
4116 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | no | no | yes
4119 Arguments :
4120 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4121 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004122 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004123
4124 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4125 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4126 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4127 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4128 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4129 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4130 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4131
4132 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4133 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4134 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4135 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4136 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4137
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004138 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4139 consistent hashing mechanism.
4140
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004141 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4142
4143
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004144hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004145 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4147 yes | no | yes | yes
4148 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004149 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4150 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004151
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004152 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4153 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4154 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4155 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4156 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4157 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4158 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4159 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4160 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4161 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004162
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004163 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4164 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4165 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4166 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4167 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4168 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4169 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4170 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4171 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4172 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4173 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4174 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4175 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004176 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4177 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004178
4179 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4180
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004181 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004182 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4183 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4184 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004185 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4186 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4187 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004188
4189 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4190 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004191 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4192 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4193 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4194 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4195
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004196 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4197 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4198 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4199 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4200 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4201 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4202 parameter.
4203
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004204 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4205 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4206 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4207 used on strings.
4208
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004209 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4210
4211 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4212 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4213 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4214 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4215 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4216 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4217 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4218 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4219 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4220 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4221 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4222 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004223
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004224 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4225 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4226 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004227
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004228 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004229
4230
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004231http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4232 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4233 ones).
4234
4235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4236 no | yes | yes | yes
4237
4238 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4239 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4240 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4241 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4242 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4243 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4244
4245 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4246 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4247 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4248
4249 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4250 below.
4251
4252 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4253 instance.
4254
4255 Example:
4256 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4257 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4258 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4259
4260http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4261
4262 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4263 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4264 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4265 example, or to pass some internal information.
4266 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4267 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4268 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4269
4270http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4271
4272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4273 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4274
4275http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4276
4277 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4278
4279http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4280 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4281
4282 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4283
4284 Example:
4285 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4286
4287 # applied to:
4288 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4289
4290 # outputs:
4291 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4292
4293 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4294
4295http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4299
4300 Example:
4301 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4302
4303 # applied to:
4304 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4305
4306 # outputs:
4307 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4308
4309http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4310
4311 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4312 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4313 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4314
4315http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4316 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4317
4318 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4319 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4320 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4321 fallback.
4322
4323 Example:
4324 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4325 http-response set-status 431
4326 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4327 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4328
4329http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4330
4331 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4332 inline.
4333
4334 Arguments:
4335 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4336 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4337 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4338 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4339 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4340 (request and response)
4341 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4342 processing
4343 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4344 processing
4345 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4346 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4347 and '_'.
4348
4349 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4350 followed by some converters.
4351
4352 Example:
4353 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4354
4355http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4356
4357 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4358 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4359 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4360 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4361 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004362 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004363 processing.
4364
4365 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4366 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4367 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4368 rules evaluation.
4369
4370http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4371
4372 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4373 details about <var-name>.
4374
4375 Example:
4376 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4377
4378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004379http-check disable-on-404
4380 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004383 Arguments : none
4384
4385 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4386 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4387 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4388 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4389 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4390 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4391 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4392 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004393 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4394 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4395 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4396
4397 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4398
4399
4400http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004401 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004403 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004404 Arguments :
4405 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4406 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004407 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004408 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4409 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4410 details on the supported keywords.
4411
4412 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4413 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4414 with the usual backslash ('\').
4415
4416 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4417 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4418 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4419 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4420 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4421
4422 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004423 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004424 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4425 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4426 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4427
4428 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004429 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004430 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4431 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4432 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4433 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4434
4435 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004436 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004437 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4438 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4439 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4440 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4441 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004442 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004443 trace).
4444
4445 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004446 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004447 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4448 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4449 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4450 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4451 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004452 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004453
4454 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4455 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4456 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4457 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4458 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4459 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4460 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4461 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4462
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004463 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4464 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4465 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004467 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4468 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4469
4470 Examples :
4471 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004472 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004473
4474 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004475 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004476
4477 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004478 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004479
4480 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004481 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004482
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484
4485
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004486http-check send-state
4487 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 yes | no | yes | yes
4490 Arguments : none
4491
4492 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4493 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4494 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4495 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4496 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4497
4498 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4499 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4500 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4501 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4502 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004503 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4504 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4505 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4506
4507 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4508 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4509 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4510
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004511 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4512 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4513 checked in multiple backends.
4514
4515 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4516 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4517
4518 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4519 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4520 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4521 one fails.
4522
4523 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4524 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4525 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4526
4527 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4528 server's queue.
4529
4530 Example of a header received by the application server :
4531 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4532 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4533
4534 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536
4537http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004538 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4539
4540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 no | yes | yes | yes
4542
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004543 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4544 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4545 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4546 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4547 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4550 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004554 Example:
4555 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4556 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4557 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559 http-request allow if nagios
4560 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4561 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4562 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004564 Example:
4565 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4566 acl add path /addacl
4567 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4572 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 Example:
4575 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4576 acl setmap path /setmap
4577 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4582 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4585 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4590 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4591 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4592 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4593 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4594 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4595 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4596 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4601 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4602 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4603 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4604 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4605 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4606 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4607 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4612 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004613
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4618 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4619 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4620 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4621 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 Example:
4624 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4625 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004627http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004628
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004629 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4632 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4635 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4636 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4637 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4638 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4639 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4640 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4641 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4642 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004644 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4645 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4646 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004647 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4648
4649 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4650 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4651 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4652 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4657 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4658 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4659 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4660 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4661 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4670 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4671 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4672 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4673 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4674 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004675
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004676http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4677 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4680 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4681 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004682 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4683 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4684 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4685 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4686 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004688
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004689http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4690 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4691 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4692 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4693
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004694http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4695
4696 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4697 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4698 pointed by <resolvers>.
4699 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4700 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4701 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4702 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4703 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4704 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4705 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4706 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4707 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4708 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4709 to 0.0.0.0.
4710
4711 Example:
4712 resolvers mydns
4713 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4714 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4715 timeout retry 1s
4716 hold valid 10s
4717 hold nx 3s
4718 hold other 3s
4719 hold obsolete 0s
4720 accepted_payload_size 8192
4721
4722 frontend fe
4723 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4724 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4725 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4726
4727 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4728 # which mean DNS resolution error
4729 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4730
4731 default_backend be
4732
4733 backend b_503
4734 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4735 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4736 # 503 error page to end users
4737
4738 backend be
4739 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4740 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4741 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4742 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4743 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4744
4745 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4746 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4747
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004748http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4749
4750 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4751 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4752 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4753 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004754 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4755 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004756
4757 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004761 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4762 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4763 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4764 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4765 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4770 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4771 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4772 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004774http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4775 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004776
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004777 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004778 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4779 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4780 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4781 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4782 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004783
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004784 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4785 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4786 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4787 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4788 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004789
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004790 Example:
4791 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4792
4793 # applied to:
4794 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4795
4796 # outputs:
4797 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4798
4799 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004800
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004801 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4802
4803 # applied to:
4804 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004805
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004806 # outputs:
4807 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004808
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004809http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811
4812 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4813 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4814 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4815 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4816
4817 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4818 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4819 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4820
4821 Example:
4822 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4823 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4824
4825 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4826 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4827
4828 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4829 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4830 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4831 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4832
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004833http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4835
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004836 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4837 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4838 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4839 against.
4840
4841 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4842 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4843 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004844
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004845 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4846 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4847 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4848 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4849 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4850 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4851 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4852 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4853 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004854 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4855 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004856
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004857 Example:
4858 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4859 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004860
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004861 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4862 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004864http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004866
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004867 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4868 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4869 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4870 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004871
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004872 Example:
4873 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004874
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004875 # applied to:
4876 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004877
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004878 # outputs:
4879 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004880
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004881http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4882 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4883 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004884 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004885 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4886
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004888 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4889 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4890 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4891 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004892 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004893 are followed to create the response :
4894
4895 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4896 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4897 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4898 ignored.
4899
4900 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4901 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4902 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4903 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4904 ignored.
4905
4906 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4907 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4908 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4909 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4910 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4911
4912 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4913 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4914 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4915 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4916 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4917 if any, is ignored.
4918
4919 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4920 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4921 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4922 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4923 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4924 as a raw content.
4925
4926 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4927 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4928 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4929 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4930 considered as a raw string.
4931
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004932 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4933 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4934 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4935 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4936
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004937 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4938 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4939 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4940
4941 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4942
4943 Example:
4944 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4945 if { path /ping }
4946
4947 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4948 if { path /favicon.ico }
4949
4950 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4951 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4952 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004954http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4955http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004957 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4958 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4959 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004960
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004961http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004963
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004964 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4965 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4966 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4967 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004968
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004969http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004971 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4972 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4973 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4974 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4975 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004977 Arguments:
4978 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4979 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004981 Example:
4982 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4983 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4986 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004988http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004989
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004990 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4991 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4992 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 Arguments:
4995 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4996 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 Example:
4999 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5000 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005002 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5003 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5004 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005008 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5009 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5010 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5011 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5012 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014 Example:
5015 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5016 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5017 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5018 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5019 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5020 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5021 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5022 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5023 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005025http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005027 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5028 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5029 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5030 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5031 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005033http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005036 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5037 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5038 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5039 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5040 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5041 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5042 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5043 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5044 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005046http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005048 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5049 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5050 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5051 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5052 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5053 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5054 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005058 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5059 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5060 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5065 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5066 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5067 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5068 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5069 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5070 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5071 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005073http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005075 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5076 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5077 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5078 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5079 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5080 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005082 Example :
5083 # prepend the host name before the path
5084 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005088 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5089 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5090 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5091 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5092 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5097 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5098 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5099 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5100 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5101 values have higher priority.
5102 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5103 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5104 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5105 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5106 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005110 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5111 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5112 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5113 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5114 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5115 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5116 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005119
5120 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005121 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5122 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5125 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5126 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5127 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005128 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5129 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005130
5131 Arguments :
5132 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5133 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005134
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005135 See also "option forwardfor".
5136
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005137 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5139 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5140
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005141 # After the masking this will track connections
5142 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5143 http-request track-sc0 src
5144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5146 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5147
5148http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5149
5150 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5151 expression.
5152
5153 Arguments:
5154 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5155 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005156
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005157 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005158 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5159 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5160
5161 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5162 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5163 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5164
5165http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5166
5167 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5168 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5169 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5170 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5171 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5172 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5173 information from the request.
5174
5175 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5176
5177http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5178
5179 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5180 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5181 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5182 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5183 path and the query string.
5184 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5185
5186http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187
5188 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5189 inline.
5190
5191 Arguments:
5192 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5193 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5194 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5195 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5196 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5197 (request and response)
5198 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5199 processing
5200 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5201 processing
5202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5203 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5204 and '_'.
5205
5206 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5207 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005208
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005209 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005210 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005212http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005215 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5216 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5217 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5218 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5219 agent name must be used.
5220
5221 Arguments:
5222 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5223
5224 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5225 configuration.
5226
5227http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5228
5229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5230 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5231 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5232 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5233 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5234 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5235 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5236 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5237 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5238 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5239 action.
5240 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5241 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5242 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5243 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5244 you fully understand how it works.
5245
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005246http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5247
5248 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5249 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5250 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5251 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5252 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005253 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005254 processing.
5255
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005256 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005257 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5258 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5259 rules evaluation.
5260
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005261http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5262 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005263
5264 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5265 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5266 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5267 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5268 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5269 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5270 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5271 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5272 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5273 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5274 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005275 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5276 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5277 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5278 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5279 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005280 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5281
5282http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5283http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5284http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5287 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5288 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5289 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5290 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5291 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5292 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5293 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5294 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5295 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5296 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5297 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5298
5299 Arguments :
5300 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5301 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5302 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5303 select which table entry to update the counters.
5304
5305 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5306 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5307 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5308 that table until the session ends.
5309
5310 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5311 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5312 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5313 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5314 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5315 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5316 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5317 useful information.
5318
5319 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5320 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5321 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5322 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5323 checks that make use of it.
5324
5325http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005328
5329 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005331
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005332http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333
5334 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5335 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5336 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5337 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5338 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5339 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5340
5341 Arguments :
5342 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5343
5344 Example:
5345 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5350 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5351 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005352
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005354http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005355 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5356
5357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 no | yes | yes | yes
5359
5360 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5361 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5362 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5363 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5364 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5365 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005367 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5368 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005369
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005370 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005371
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005372 Example:
5373 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005374
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005375 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005376
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005377 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5378 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005380 Example:
5381 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005383 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005385 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5386 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005388 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5389 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005393 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5394 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5395 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5396 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5397 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5398 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5399 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5400 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005402http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005404 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5405 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5406 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5407 example, or to pass some internal information.
5408 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5409 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5410 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005414 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5415 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005416
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005417http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005418
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005419 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005421http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005423 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5424 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5425 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5426 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5427 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5428 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5429 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5432 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5433 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5434 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5435 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005436
5437 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5438 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5439 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5440 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005442http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005444 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5445 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5446 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5447 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5448 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5449 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005451http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005453 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005454
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005455http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005457 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5458 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5459 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5460 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5461 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5462 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005463
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005464http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005467 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005468 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5469 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005470 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5471 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5472 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5473 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5474 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005475 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005477http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005479 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5480 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5481 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5482 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5483 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5484 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005485
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005486http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5487 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005488
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005489 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5490 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005492 Example:
5493 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005494
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005495 # applied to:
5496 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005498 # outputs:
5499 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005500
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005501 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005503http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005505
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005506 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005507 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005508
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005509 Example:
5510 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005511
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005512 # applied to:
5513 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005515 # outputs:
5516 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005517
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005518http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5519 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5520 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005521 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5523
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005524 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005525 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5526 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5527 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5528 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005529 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005530 are followed to create the response :
5531
5532 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5533 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5534 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5535 ignored.
5536
5537 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5538 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5539 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5540 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5541 ignored.
5542
5543 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5544 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5545 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5546 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5547 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5548
5549 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5550 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5551 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5552 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5553 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5554 if any, is ignored.
5555
5556 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5557 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5558 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5559 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5560 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5561 as a raw content.
5562
5563 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5564 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5565 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5566 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5567 considered as a raw string.
5568
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005569 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5570 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5571 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5572 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5573
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005574 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5575 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5576 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5577
5578 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5579
5580 Example:
5581 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5582 if { status eq 404 }
5583
5584 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5585 string "This is the end !" \
5586 if { status eq 500 }
5587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005588http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5589http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005591 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5592 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5593 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005594
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005595http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005597
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005598 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5599 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5600 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5601 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005602
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005603http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005605 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5606 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5607 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5608 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5609 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005611 Arguments:
5612 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005614 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5615 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005617http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005619 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5620 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5621 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005623http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5624
5625 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5626 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5627 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5628 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5629 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5630
5631http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5632
5633 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5634 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5635 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5636 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5637 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5638 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5639 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5640 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5641 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5642
5643http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5644
5645 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5646 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5647 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5648 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5649 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5650 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5651 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5652
5653http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5654
5655 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5656 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5657 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5658 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5659 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5660 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5661 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5662 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5663
5664http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5665 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5666
5667 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5668 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5669 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5670 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005671
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005672 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005673 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5674 http-response set-status 431
5675 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5676 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005678http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005680 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5681 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5682 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5683 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5684 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5685 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5686 based on some information from the request.
5687
5688 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5689
5690http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5691
5692 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5693 inline.
5694
5695 Arguments:
5696 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5697 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5701 (request and response)
5702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5703 processing
5704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5705 processing
5706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5707 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5708 and '_'.
5709
5710 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5711 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005712
5713 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005714 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005716http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005718 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5719 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5720 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5721 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5722 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5723 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5724 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5725 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5726 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5727 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5728 action.
5729 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5730 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5731 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5732 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5733 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005734
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005735http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5736
5737 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5738 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5739 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5740 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5741 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005742 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005743 processing.
5744
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005745 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005746 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5747 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5748 rules evaluation.
5749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005750http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5751http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5752http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005754 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5755 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5756 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5757 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5758 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5759 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5760
5761http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5762
5763 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5764 about <var-name>.
5765
5766 Example:
5767 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5768
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005769
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005770http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5771 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5772
5773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | no | yes | yes
5775
5776 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005777 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5778 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5779 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005780
5781 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5782
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005783 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5784 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5785 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5786 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5787 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5788 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5789 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5790 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5791 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5792 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005793
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005794 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5795 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5796 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5797 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5798 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5799 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5800 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5801 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005802
5803 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5804 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5805 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5806 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5807 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5808 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5809 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5810 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005811 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005812 downsides of rare connection failures.
5813
5814 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5815 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5816 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5817 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5818 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5819 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005820 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005821 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5822 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5823 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5824 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5825 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5826
5827 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5829 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5830 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005831
5832 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005833 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005834
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005835 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5836 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005837
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005838 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005839
5840 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5841 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5842 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5843
5844 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5845
5846
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005847http-send-name-header [<header>]
5848 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005851 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005852 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5853
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005854 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5855 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5856 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5857 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5858 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5859 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5860 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5861 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5862 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5863 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5864 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5865 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5866 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5867 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5868 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5869 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005870
5871 See also : "server"
5872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005873id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005874 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 no | yes | yes | yes
5877 Arguments : none
5878
5879 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5880 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5881 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005882
5883
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005884ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5885 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005887 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005888
5889 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5890 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5891 and running).
5892
5893 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5894 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5895 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005896 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005897 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5898
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005899 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5900 "unless" condition is met.
5901
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005902 Example:
5903 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5904 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5905 ignore-persist if url_static
5906
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005907 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5908
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005909load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5910 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 yes | no | yes | yes
5913
5914 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5915 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5916 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005917 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005918 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5919 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5920 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5921 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5922
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005923 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005924 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005925 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005926
5927 Arguments:
5928 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5929 named "server-state-file".
5930
5931 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5932 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5933 name is used as a file name.
5934
5935 none don't load any stat for this backend
5936
5937 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005938 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5939 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5940 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005941 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005942 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005943
5944 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5945 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5946
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005947 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005948
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005949 global
5950 stats socket /tmp/socket
5951 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005952
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005953 defaults
5954 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005955
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005956 backend bk
5957 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5958 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005959
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005960
5961 Then one can run :
5962
5963 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5964
5965 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5966
5967 1
5968 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5969 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5970 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5971
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005972 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005973
5974 global
5975 stats socket /tmp/socket
5976 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5977
5978 defaults
5979 load-server-state-from-file local
5980
5981 backend bk
5982 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5983 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5984
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005985
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005986 Then one can run :
5987
5988 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5989
5990 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5991
5992 1
5993 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5994 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5995 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5996
5997 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5998 "show servers state"
5999
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006001log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006002log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6003 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006004no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006005 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006008
6009 Prefix :
6010 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6011 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6012 prefix does not allow arguments.
6013
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006014 Arguments :
6015 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6016 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6017 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6018 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6019 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6020 parameter.
6021
6022 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6023 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6024
6025 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6026 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6027 standard syslog port).
6028
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006029 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6030 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6031 standard syslog port).
6032
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006033 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6034 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6035 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006036 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006037
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006038 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6039 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6040 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6041 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6042 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6043 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6044 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6045 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6046 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6047 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6048 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6049 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6050 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6051 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6052 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6053 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006054 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6055 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006056
6057 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6058 and "fd@2", see above.
6059
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006060 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6061 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6062 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6063 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6064 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6065 having the logs instantly available.
6066
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006069
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006070 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6071 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6072 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6073 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6074 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6075 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6076 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6077 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6078 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6079 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006080 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006081
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006082 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6083 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6084 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6085 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6086 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6087
6088 <sample_size>
6089 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6090 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6091 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6092 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6093 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6094
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006095 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6096 one of the following :
6097
6098 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6099 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6100
6101 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6102 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6103
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006104 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6105 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6106 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6107 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6108 systemd logger consumes.
6109
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006110 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6111 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6112 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6113 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6114
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006115 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6116
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006117 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6118 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6119 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6120
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006121 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6122 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6123 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6124 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006125
6126 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6127 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6128 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006129 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6130 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6131 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6132 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6133 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006134
6135 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6136
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006137 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6138 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6139 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006140
6141 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6142 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6143 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6144 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6145
6146 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6147 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006148
6149 Example :
6150 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006151 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6152 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6153 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006154 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6155 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006156 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006157
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006158
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006159log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006160 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006163
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006164 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6165 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6166 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6167 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6168 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006169
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006170 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6171 "option httplog" directives.
6172
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006173log-format-sd <string>
6174 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6175 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | yes | yes | no
6177
6178 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6179 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6180 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6181 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6182 which covers the log format string in depth.
6183
6184 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6185 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6186
6187 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6188 log format to "rfc5424".
6189
6190 Example :
6191 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6192
6193
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006194log-tag <string>
6195 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | yes | yes | yes
6198
6199 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6200 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6201 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6202 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6203 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6204 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6205 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6206 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6207 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006208
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006209max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6210 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6212 yes | no | yes | yes
6213
6214 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6215 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6216 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6217 servers.
6218
6219 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6220 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6221 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6222 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6223 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006224 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006225 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6226 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6227 picking a different server.
6228
6229 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6230 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6231 even if they have to be queued.
6232
6233 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6234 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6235
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006236max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6237 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6238 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6239 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006240
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006241maxconn <conns>
6242 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | yes | yes | no
6245 Arguments :
6246 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6247 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6248 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6249 closes.
6250
6251 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6252 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6253 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6254 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006255 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6256 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6257 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6258 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006259
6260 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6261 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6262 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6263
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006264 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6265 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006266
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006267 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6268
6269
6270mode { tcp|http|health }
6271 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6273 yes | yes | yes | yes
6274 Arguments :
6275 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6276 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6277 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6278 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6279
6280 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6281 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6282 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6283 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6284 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6285
6286 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006287 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6288 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6289 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6290 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6291 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6292 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6293 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006294
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006295 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6296 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6297 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006298
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006299 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006300 defaults http_instances
6301 mode http
6302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006303 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006305
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006306monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006307 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6309 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006310 Arguments :
6311 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6312 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006313 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006314 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6315 backend and its backup.
6316
6317 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6318 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6319 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6320 servers in a list of backends.
6321
6322 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6323 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6324 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6325 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6326 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6327 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6328 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006329 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6330 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006331
6332 Example:
6333 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006334 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006335 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6336 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6337 monitor-uri /site_alive
6338 monitor fail if site_dead
6339
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006340 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006341
6342
6343monitor-net <source>
6344 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 yes | yes | yes | no
6347 Arguments :
6348 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6349 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6350 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6351 followed by a mask.
6352
6353 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6354 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006355 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006356 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6357
6358 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6359 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6360 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6361 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006362 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6363 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6364 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006365
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006366 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6367 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6368 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6369 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6370 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6371 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006372
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006373 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6374 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006375
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006376 Example :
6377 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6378 frontend www
6379 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6380
6381 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6382
6383
6384monitor-uri <uri>
6385 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | yes | yes | no
6388 Arguments :
6389 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6390 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6391
6392 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6393 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6394 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6395 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6396 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6397 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6398 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6399 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6400
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006401 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006402 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6403 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6404 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6405 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6406 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6407 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006408
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006409 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6410 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6411 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6412 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006414 Example :
6415 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6416 frontend www
6417 mode http
6418 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6419
6420 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006422
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006423option abortonclose
6424no option abortonclose
6425 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6427 yes | no | yes | yes
6428 Arguments : none
6429
6430 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6431 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6432 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6433 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006434 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006435 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6436 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6437 encountered while delivering the response.
6438
6439 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6440 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6441 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6442 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6443 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6444 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006445 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006446 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006447 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006448 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6449 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6450 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6451
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006452 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6453 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006454 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6455 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6456 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6457 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6458 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6459 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006460 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006461
6462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6464
6465 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6466
6467
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006468option accept-invalid-http-request
6469no option accept-invalid-http-request
6470 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6472 yes | yes | yes | no
6473 Arguments : none
6474
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006475 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006476 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006477 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006478 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6479 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6480 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6481 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6482 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006483 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6484 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6485 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6486 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006487 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006488 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006489 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6490 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6491 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006492
6493 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6494 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6495 been confirmed.
6496
6497 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6498 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006499 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6500 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006501 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6502
6503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6505
6506 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6507 stats socket.
6508
6509
6510option accept-invalid-http-response
6511no option accept-invalid-http-response
6512 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6514 yes | no | yes | yes
6515 Arguments : none
6516
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006517 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006518 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006519 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006520 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6521 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6522 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6523 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6524 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006525 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6526 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6527 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006528
6529 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6530 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6531 been confirmed.
6532
6533 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6534 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6535 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6536 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6537
6538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6540
6541 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6542 stats socket.
6543
6544
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006545option allbackups
6546no option allbackups
6547 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6549 yes | no | yes | yes
6550 Arguments : none
6551
6552 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6553 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6554 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6555 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6556 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6557 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6558 order between the backup servers anymore.
6559
6560 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6561 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6562
6563 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6564 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6565
6566
6567option checkcache
6568no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006569 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6571 yes | no | yes | yes
6572 Arguments : none
6573
6574 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6575 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006576 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006577 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6578 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006579 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006580
6581 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006582 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006583 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006584 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6585 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006586 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006587 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006588 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6589 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006590 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006591 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6592 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006593 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006594 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6595 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6596 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6597 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6598 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6599 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6600 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6601 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6602 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6603
6604 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006605 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6606 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6607 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6608 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006609
6610 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6611 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006612 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006613 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006614
6615 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6616 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6617
6618
6619option clitcpka
6620no option clitcpka
6621 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | yes | yes | no
6624 Arguments : none
6625
6626 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6627 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006629 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6630
6631 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6632 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6633 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6634 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6635
6636 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6637 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6638 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6639 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6640 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6641
6642 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6643
6644 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6645 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6646 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6647
6648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6650
6651 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6652
6653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006654option contstats
6655 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | no
6658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6661 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6662 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6663 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006664 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6665 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6666 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6667 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6668 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006669
6670
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006671option dontlog-normal
6672no option dontlog-normal
6673 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6675 yes | yes | yes | no
6676 Arguments : none
6677
6678 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6679 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6680 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6681 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6682 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6683 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6684 logged.
6685
6686 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6687 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6688 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006690 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006691 logging.
6692
6693
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006694option dontlognull
6695no option dontlognull
6696 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 yes | yes | yes | no
6699 Arguments : none
6700
6701 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6702 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6703 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6704 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6705 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6706 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006707 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6708 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6709 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006710
6711 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006712 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006713 would not be logged.
6714
6715 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6716 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6717
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006718 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6719 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006720
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006721
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006722option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006723 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | yes | yes | yes
6726 Arguments :
6727 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6728 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006729 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006730 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006731
6732 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6733 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6734 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6735 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6736 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6737 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6738 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006739 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6740 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6741 possible that the client has already brought one.
6742
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006743 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006744 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006745 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006746 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006747 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006748 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006749
6750 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6751 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6752 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6753 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6754 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6755 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6756 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6757
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006758 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6759 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6760 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6761 are under the control of the end-user.
6762
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006763 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006764 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6765 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006766 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6767 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6768 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006769
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006770 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6772 frontend www
6773 mode http
6774 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6775
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006776 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6777 backend www
6778 mode http
6779 option forwardfor header X-Client
6780
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006781 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006782 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006783
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006784
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006785option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6786no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6787 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | yes | yes | no
6790 Arguments : none
6791
6792 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6793 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6794 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6795 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6796 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6797 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6798 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6799
6800 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6801 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6802 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6803 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6804 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6805 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6806 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6807 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6808 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6809 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6810
6811 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6812
6813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6815
6816 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6817 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6818
6819
6820option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6821no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6822 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 yes | no | yes | yes
6825 Arguments : none
6826
6827 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6828 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6829 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6830 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6831 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6832 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6833 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6834
6835 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6836 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6837 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6838 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6839 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6840 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6841 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6842 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6843 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6844 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6845
6846 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6847
6848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6850
6851 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6852 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6853
6854
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006855option http-buffer-request
6856no option http-buffer-request
6857 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6859 yes | yes | yes | yes
6860 Arguments : none
6861
6862 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6863 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6864 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6865 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6866 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6867 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006868 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6869 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6870 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6871 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006872
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006873 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006874
6875
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006876option http-ignore-probes
6877no option http-ignore-probes
6878 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | yes | yes | no
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6884 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6885 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6886 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6887 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6888 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6889 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6890 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6891 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006892 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6893 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006894 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6895
6896 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6897 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6898 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6899 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6900 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6901 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6902 are often the only way to detect them.
6903
6904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6906
6907 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6908
6909
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006910option http-keep-alive
6911no option http-keep-alive
6912 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 yes | yes | yes | yes
6915 Arguments : none
6916
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006917 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6918 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006919 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6920 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006921 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6922 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6923 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006924
6925 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6926 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006927 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6928 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6929 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6930 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6931 situations where this option may be useful :
6932
6933 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006934 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006935
6936 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6937 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6938
6939 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6940 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6941 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6942 request.
6943
6944 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6945 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006946 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6947 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6948 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006949
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006950 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6951 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6952 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6953 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6954 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6955 not set.
6956
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006957 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6958 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6959 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006960
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006961 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006962 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006963 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006964
6965
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006966option http-no-delay
6967no option http-no-delay
6968 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | yes | yes | yes
6971 Arguments : none
6972
6973 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6974 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6975 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6976 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6977 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6978 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6979 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6980 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6981 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6982 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6983 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6984 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6985 affected.
6986
6987 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6988 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6989 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6990 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6991 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6992 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6993 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6994 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6995 latency environments.
6996
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006997 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6998
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006999
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007000option http-pretend-keepalive
7001no option http-pretend-keepalive
7002 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007005 Arguments : none
7006
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007007 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007008 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7009 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7010 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7011 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7012 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7013 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7014 consider the response complete.
7015
7016 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7017 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7018 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7019 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007020 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007021 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7022
7023 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7024 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7025 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7026 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7027 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7028 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7029 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7030
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007031 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7032 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7033 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7034 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7035 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7036 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007037
7038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7040
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007041 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007042 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007043
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007044
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007045option http-server-close
7046no option http-server-close
7047 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7049 yes | yes | yes | yes
7050 Arguments : none
7051
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007052 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7053 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7054 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7055 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007056 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7057 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7058 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7059 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7060 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7061 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7062 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7063 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7064 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7065 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7066 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007067
7068 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7069 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7070 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7071 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007072 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7073 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007074
7075 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7076 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007077 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7078 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7079 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007080
7081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7083
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007084 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7085 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007086
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007087option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007088no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007089 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7091 yes | yes | yes | no
7092 Arguments : none
7093
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007094 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007095 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7096 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7097 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7098 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7099 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7100 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7101
7102 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7103 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007104 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7105 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7106 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007107
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007108 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7109 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7110 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7111 front of an existing proxy.
7112
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007113 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7114
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007115 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007116
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007117option httpchk
7118option httpchk <uri>
7119option httpchk <method> <uri>
7120option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7121 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | no | yes | yes
7124 Arguments :
7125 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7126 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7127 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7128 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7129 ones.
7130
7131 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7132 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7133 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7134
7135 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7136 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7137 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7138 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7139 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7140
7141 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7142 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7143 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7144 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7145 the lack of any response.
7146
7147 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7148
7149 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7150 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7151 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7152
7153 Examples :
7154 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7155 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7156 backend https_relay
7157 mode tcp
7158 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7159 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7160
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007161 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7162 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7163 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007164
7165
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007166option httpclose
7167no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007168 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 yes | yes | yes | yes
7171 Arguments : none
7172
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007173 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7174 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7175 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7176 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007177 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007178
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007179 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7180 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007181 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007182 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7183 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007185 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7186 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7187 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007188
7189 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7190 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007191 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7192 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7193 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007194
7195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007198 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007199
7200
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007201option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007202 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007204 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007205 Arguments :
7206 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7207 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7208 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007209 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007210 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007211
7212 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7213 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7214 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7215 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7216 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7217 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7218 ports.
7219
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007220 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7221 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007222
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007223 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007225 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007227
7228option http_proxy
7229no option http_proxy
7230 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | yes | yes | yes
7233 Arguments : none
7234
7235 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7236 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7237 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7238 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7239 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7240
7241 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7242 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007243 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7244 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007245
7246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7248
7249 Example :
7250 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7251 backend direct_forward
7252 option httpclose
7253 option http_proxy
7254
7255 See also : "option httpclose"
7256
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007257
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007258option independent-streams
7259no option independent-streams
7260 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7262 yes | yes | yes | yes
7263 Arguments : none
7264
7265 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7266 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7267 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7268 receive data or not.
7269
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007270 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007271 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7272 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7273 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7274 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7275 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7276 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7277 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7278 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7279 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7280 socket buffers.
7281
7282 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7283 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7284 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7285 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7286 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7287
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007288 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007289
7290
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007291option ldap-check
7292 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | no | yes | yes
7295 Arguments : none
7296
7297 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7298 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7299 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7300 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7301
7302 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7303 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7304
7305 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7306 configure it.
7307
7308 Example :
7309 option ldap-check
7310
7311 See also : "option httpchk"
7312
7313
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007314option external-check
7315 Use external processes for server health checks
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | no | yes | yes
7318
7319 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7320 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7321 command".
7322
7323 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7324
7325 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7326
7327
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007328option log-health-checks
7329no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007330 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7332 yes | no | yes | yes
7333 Arguments : none
7334
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007335 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7336 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7337 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007338
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007339 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7340 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7341 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7342 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7343 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007345 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007346 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007347
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007348 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7349 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7350 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007351
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007352
7353option log-separate-errors
7354no option log-separate-errors
7355 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | no
7358 Arguments : none
7359
7360 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7361 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7362 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7363 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7364 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7365 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7366 provides very important information.
7367
7368 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7369 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7370 error logs.
7371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007372 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007373 logging.
7374
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007375
7376option logasap
7377no option logasap
7378 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 yes | yes | yes | no
7381 Arguments : none
7382
7383 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7384 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7385 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7386 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7387 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7388 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7389 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007390 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007391 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7392 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7393
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007394 Examples :
7395 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7396 mode http
7397 option httplog
7398 option logasap
7399 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7400
7401 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7402 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7403 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7404 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007406 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007407 logging.
7408
7409
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007410option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007411 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007414 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007415 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7416 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007417 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007418
7419 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7420 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007422 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7423 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7424 in the MySQL table, like this :
7425
7426 USE mysql;
7427 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7428 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7429
7430 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007431 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007432 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7433 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7434 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7435 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7436 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7437 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7438 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7439
7440 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7441 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007442
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007443 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007444
7445 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7446 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7447 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7448 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007449 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7450 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007451
7452 See also: "option httpchk"
7453
7454
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007455option nolinger
7456no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007457 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007458 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007460 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007461
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007462 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007463 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7464 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7465 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7466 connections.
7467
7468 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7469 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7470 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7471 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7472 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7473 this too.
7474
7475 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7476 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7477 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7478
7479 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7480 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7481 for servers.
7482
7483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7485
7486
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007487option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7488 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 yes | yes | yes | yes
7491 Arguments :
7492 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7493 matching <network>
7494 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7495 header name.
7496
7497 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7498 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7499 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7500 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7501 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7502 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7503 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7504 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7505 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7506 possible that the client has already brought one.
7507
7508 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7509 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7510 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7511 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7512 header and requires different one.
7513
7514 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7515 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7516 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7517 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7518 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7519 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7520 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7521
7522 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7523 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7524 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7525 both are defined.
7526
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007527 Examples :
7528 # Original Destination address
7529 frontend www
7530 mode http
7531 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7532
7533 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7534 backend www
7535 mode http
7536 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7537
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007538 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007539
7540
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007541option persist
7542no option persist
7543 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7545 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007546 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007547
7548 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7549 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7550 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7551 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7552 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7553 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7554 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7555 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7556 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7557 redirected to another valid server.
7558
7559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7561
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007562 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007563
7564
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007565option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7566 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7568 yes | no | yes | yes
7569 Arguments :
7570 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7571 PostgreSQL server.
7572
7573 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7574 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7575 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7576 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7577
7578 See also: "option httpchk"
7579
7580
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007581option prefer-last-server
7582no option prefer-last-server
7583 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7584 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7585 yes | no | yes | yes
7586 Arguments : none
7587
7588 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7589 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7590 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7591 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7592 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7593 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7594 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7595 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7596 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007597 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7598 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007599 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7600 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7601 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007602 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7603 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7604 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007605
7606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7608
7609 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7610
7611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007612option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007613option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007614no option redispatch
7615 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007618 Arguments :
7619 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7620 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7621 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007622 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007623 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007624 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007625 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7626 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7627 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007629
7630 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7631 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7632 be able to access the service anymore.
7633
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007634 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7635 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007636
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007637 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7638 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7639 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7640 following order:
7641
7642 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7643
7644 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7645 list, or
7646
7647 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7648
7649 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7650 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7651
7652 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7653 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7654 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7655 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7656
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007657 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007658 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7659 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7663
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007664 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007665
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007666
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007667option redis-check
7668 Use redis health checks for server testing
7669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7670 yes | no | yes | yes
7671 Arguments : none
7672
7673 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7674 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7675 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7676 find the "+PONG" response message.
7677
7678 Example :
7679 option redis-check
7680
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007681 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007682
7683
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007684option smtpchk
7685option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7686 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007689 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007690 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007691 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007692 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7693
7694 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7695 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7696 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7697
7698 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7699 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7700 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7701 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7702 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7703 dead server.
7704
7705 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7706 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007707 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007708 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7709
7710 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7711 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7712 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7713 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007714 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007715
7716 Example :
7717 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7718
7719 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007722option socket-stats
7723no option socket-stats
7724
7725 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7727 yes | yes | yes | no
7728
7729 Arguments : none
7730
7731
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007732option splice-auto
7733no option splice-auto
7734 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | yes | yes | yes
7737 Arguments : none
7738
7739 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7740 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007741 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007742 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007743 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007744 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7745 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7746 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7747 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7748
7749 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7750 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7751 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7752 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7753 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7754 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7755 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7756 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7757 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7758 keyword.
7759
7760 Example :
7761 option splice-auto
7762
7763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7765
7766 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7767 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7768
7769
7770option splice-request
7771no option splice-request
7772 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | yes
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007778 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007779 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7780 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7781 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7782 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7783
7784 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7785
7786 Example :
7787 option splice-request
7788
7789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7791
7792 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7793 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7794
7795
7796option splice-response
7797no option splice-response
7798 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 yes | yes | yes | yes
7801 Arguments : none
7802
7803 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007804 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007805 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7806 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7807 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7808 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7809
7810 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7811
7812 Example :
7813 option splice-response
7814
7815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7817
7818 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7819 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7820
7821
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007822option spop-check
7823 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 no | no | no | yes
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7829 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7830 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7831 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7832
7833 Example :
7834 option spop-check
7835
7836 See also : "option httpchk"
7837
7838
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007839option srvtcpka
7840no option srvtcpka
7841 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7843 yes | no | yes | yes
7844 Arguments : none
7845
7846 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7847 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007848 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007849 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7850
7851 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7852 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7853 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7854 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7855
7856 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7857 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7858 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7859 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7860 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7861
7862 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7863
7864 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7865 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7866 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7867
7868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7870
7871 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7872
7873
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007874option ssl-hello-chk
7875 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 yes | no | yes | yes
7878 Arguments : none
7879
7880 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7881 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7882 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7883 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7884 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7885 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7886 hello message.
7887
7888 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7889 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7890 messages, which is appreciable.
7891
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007892 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7893 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7894 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007895
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007896 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7897
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007898
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007899option tcp-check
7900 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7902 yes | no | yes | yes
7903
7904 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7905 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7906
7907 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7908 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7909 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7910
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007911 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007912 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7913 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7914 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7915 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7916 only.
7917
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007918 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007919 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7920 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7921 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7922 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7923
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007924 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007925 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7926 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007927 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007928 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7929 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7930 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7931 the respective protocols.
7932 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007933 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007934
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007935 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7936 script.
7937
7938 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7939 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7940 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7941 The "comment" is of course optional.
7942
7943
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007944 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007945 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007946 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007947 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007949 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007950 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007951 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007952
7953 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7954 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007955 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007956 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007957 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007958 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007959 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007960 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007961 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7962 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007963 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007964 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7965 tcp-check expect string +OK
7966
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007967 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007968 (send many headers before analyzing)
7969 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007970 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007971 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7972 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7973 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7974 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007975 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007976
7977
7978 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7979
7980
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007981option tcp-smart-accept
7982no option tcp-smart-accept
7983 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7985 yes | yes | yes | no
7986 Arguments : none
7987
7988 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7989 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7990 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7991 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7992 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7993 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7994
7995 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7996 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7997 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7998 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7999
8000 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8001 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8002 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008003 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008004
8005 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8006 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8007 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8008
8009 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8010 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8011 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8012
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008013 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8014
8015
8016option tcp-smart-connect
8017no option tcp-smart-connect
8018 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8020 yes | no | yes | yes
8021 Arguments : none
8022
8023 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8024 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8025 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8026 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8027 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8028
8029 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8030 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8031 complex.
8032
8033 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8034 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8035 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8036
8037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8039
8040 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8041
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008042
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008043option tcpka
8044 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8046 yes | yes | yes | yes
8047 Arguments : none
8048
8049 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8050 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008051 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008052 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8053
8054 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8055 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8056 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8057 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8058
8059 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8060 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8061 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8062 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8063 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8064
8065 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8066
8067 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8068 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8069 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8070 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8071 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8072 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8073 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8074 backends.
8075
8076 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8077
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008078
8079option tcplog
8080 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008082 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008083 Arguments : none
8084
8085 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8086 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8087 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8088 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8089 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8090 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8091 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8092 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8093
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008094 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008096 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008097
8098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008099option transparent
8100no option transparent
8101 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008104 Arguments : none
8105
8106 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8107 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8108 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8109 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8110 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8111 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8112 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8113 appropriate server.
8114
8115 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8116 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8117
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008118 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008120
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008121
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008122external-check command <command>
8123 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 yes | no | yes | yes
8126
8127 Arguments :
8128 <command> is the external command to run
8129
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008130 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8131
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008132 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008133
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008134 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8135 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8136 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8137 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8138 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8139 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008140
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008141 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8142
8143 Environment variables :
8144 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8145 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8146
8147 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8148
8149 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8150
8151 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8152 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8153 for a UNIX socket).
8154
8155 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8156
8157 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8158
8159 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8160
8161 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8162
8163 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8164
8165 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8166 socket).
8167
8168 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8169 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8170
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008171 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8172
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008173 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8174 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8175 failed.
8176
8177 Example :
8178 external-check command /bin/true
8179
8180 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8181
8182
8183external-check path <path>
8184 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 yes | no | yes | yes
8187
8188 Arguments :
8189 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8190
8191 The default path is "".
8192
8193 Example :
8194 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8195
8196 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8197 "external-check command"
8198
8199
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008200persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008201persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008202 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 yes | no | yes | yes
8205 Arguments :
8206 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008207 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8208 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008209
8210 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8211 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008212 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008213 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8214 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8215 forwarded to this server.
8216
8217 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8218 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8219 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008220 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008221 a single "listen" section.
8222
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008223 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8224 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8225 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8226
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008227 Example :
8228 listen tse-farm
8229 bind :3389
8230 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8231 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8232 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8233 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8234 persist rdp-cookie
8235 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008236 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008237 balance rdp-cookie
8238 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8239 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8240
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008241 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8242 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008243
8244
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008245rate-limit sessions <rate>
8246 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8248 yes | yes | yes | no
8249 Arguments :
8250 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8251 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8252
8253 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8254 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8255 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8256 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8257 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8258 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8259
8260 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8261 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8262 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8263 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8264
8265 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8266 listen smtp
8267 mode tcp
8268 bind :25
8269 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008270 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008271
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008272 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8273 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8274 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008275
8276 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8277
8278
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008279redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8280redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8281redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008282 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8284 no | yes | yes | yes
8285
8286 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008287 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008288
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008290 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008291 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8292 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8293 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008294
8295 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8296 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8297 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8298 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8299 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008300 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8301 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8302 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8303 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008304
8305 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8306 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8307 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8308 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8309 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8310 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008311 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008312 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008313 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8314 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8315 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008316
8317 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008318 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8319 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8320 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008321 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008322 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8323 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8324 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8325 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008326
8327 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008328 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008329
8330 - "drop-query"
8331 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8332 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8333 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8334 with a location-type redirect.
8335
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008336 - "append-slash"
8337 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8338 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8339 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8340 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8341
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008342 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8343 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8344 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8345 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8346 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8347 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8348 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8349
8350 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8351 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8352 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8353 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8354 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8355 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8356 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008357
8358 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8359 acl clear dst_port 80
8360 acl secure dst_port 8080
8361 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008362 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008363 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008364 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8365
8366 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008367 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8368 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8369 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008370 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008371
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008372 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8373 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8374 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8375
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008376 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008377 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008378
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008379 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008380 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8381 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8382 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008386
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008387retries <value>
8388 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8390 yes | no | yes | yes
8391 Arguments :
8392 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8393 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8394 default value is 3.
8395
8396 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8397 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8398 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8399
8400 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008401 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8402 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008403
8404 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8405 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8406
8407 See also : "option redispatch"
8408
8409
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008410retry-on [list of keywords]
8411 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8412 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | no | yes | yes
8414 Arguments :
8415 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8416 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8417 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8418 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8419
8420 none never retry
8421
8422 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8423 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8424
8425 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8426 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8427 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8428 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8429 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8430 processing the request.
8431
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008432 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8433 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8434 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8435 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8436 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8437 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8438 overflow attack for example).
8439
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008440 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8441 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8442 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8443 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8444 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8445 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8446 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8447 amplify denial of service attacks.
8448
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008449 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8450 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8451 considered to be safe to retry.
8452
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008453 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8454 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8455 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8456 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8457
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008458 all-retryable-errors
8459 retry request for any error that are considered
8460 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8461 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8462 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8463
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008464 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8465 not cumulative.
8466
8467 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8468 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8469 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8470 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8471
8472 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8473 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8474 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8475 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8476 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8477 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8478 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8479 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8480 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8481 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8482 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8483 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8484
8485 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8486 should not use this directive.
8487
8488 The default is "conn-failure".
8489
8490 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8491
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008492server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008493 Declare a server in a backend
8494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 no | no | yes | yes
8496 Arguments :
8497 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008498 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008499 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008500
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008501 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8502 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8503 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8504 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008505 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8506 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8507 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8508 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8509 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008510 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8511 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8512 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8513 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8514 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8515 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8516 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008517 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008518 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8519 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8520 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8521 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8522 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8523 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008524 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8525 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008526 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8527 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008528
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008529 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008530 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8531 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8532 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8533 adding this value to the client's port.
8534
8535 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8536 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008537 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538
8539 Examples :
8540 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8541 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008542 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008543 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8544 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8545 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008547 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8548 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8549 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8550 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8551 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8552
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008553 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8554 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008555
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008556server-state-file-name [<file>]
8557 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8558 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8559 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8560 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8561 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8562 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8563
8564 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8565 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8566
8567 global
8568 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8569
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008570 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008571 load-server-state-from-file
8572
8573 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8574 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008575
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008576server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8577 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8578 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8580 no | no | yes | yes
8581
8582 Arguments:
8583 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8584
8585 <num | range>
8586 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8587 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8588 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8589 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8590
8591 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8592
8593 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8594
8595 <params*>
8596 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8597 keyword.
8598
8599 Examples:
8600 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8601 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8602 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8603
8604 # or
8605 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8606
8607 # would be equivalent to:
8608 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8609 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8610 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8611
8612
8613
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008614source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008615source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008616source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8619 yes | no | yes | yes
8620 Arguments :
8621 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8622 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008623
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008624 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008625 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8626 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8627 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8628 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8629 supported prefixes are :
8630 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8631 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8632 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008633 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008634 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8635 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008636
8637 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8638 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008639 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8640 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8641 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008642
8643 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8644 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8645 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8646 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8647 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8648 <addr>.
8649
8650 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8651 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8652 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8653 port.
8654
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008655 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8656 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8657 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8658 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008659 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008660 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8661 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8662 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8663 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8664 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8665 HTTP header.
8666
8667 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8668 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008669 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008670 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8671 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8672 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8673 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8674 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8675 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8676 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8677
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008678 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8679 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8680 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8681 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8682 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8683 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8684
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008685 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8686 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8687 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8688 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8689
8690 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8691 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8692 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8693 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8694 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8695 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8696
8697 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8698 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8699 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8700 there are two methods :
8701
8702 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8703 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8704 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8705 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8706 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8707 of the client ranges may be used.
8708
8709 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8710 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8711 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8712 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8713 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8714 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8715 same session.
8716
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008717 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8718 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8719 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008720 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008721
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008722 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8723
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724 Examples :
8725 backend private
8726 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8727 source 192.168.1.200
8728
8729 backend transparent_ssl1
8730 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8731 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8732
8733 backend transparent_ssl2
8734 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8735 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8736 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8737
8738 backend transparent_ssl3
8739 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8740 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8741 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8742
8743 backend transparent_smtp
8744 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8745 # with Tproxy version 4.
8746 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8747
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008748 backend transparent_http
8749 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8750 # proxy.
8751 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008754 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8755
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008756
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008757stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8758 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008760 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008761
8762 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8763 matched.
8764
8765 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8766 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8767
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008768 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8769 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008770 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008771
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008772 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8773 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8774 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8775 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008776
8777 Example :
8778 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8779 backend stats_localhost
8780 stats enable
8781 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8782
8783 Example :
8784 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8785 backend stats_auth
8786 stats enable
8787 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8788 stats admin if TRUE
8789
8790 Example :
8791 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8792 userlist stats-auth
8793 group admin users admin
8794 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8795 group readonly users haproxy
8796 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8797
8798 backend stats_auth
8799 stats enable
8800 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8801 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8802 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8803 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8804
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008805 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8806 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8807 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008808
8809
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008810stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8811 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008813 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008814 Arguments :
8815 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8816
8817 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8818
8819 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8820 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8821 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8822 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8823 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8824 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8825
8826 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8827 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8828 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008829 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008830
8831 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8832 report using "stats scope".
8833
8834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8836 unobvious parameters.
8837
8838 Example :
8839 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8840 backend public_www
8841 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8842 stats enable
8843 stats hide-version
8844 stats scope .
8845 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008847 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8848 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8849
8850 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8851 backend private_monitoring
8852 stats enable
8853 stats uri /admin?stats
8854 stats refresh 5s
8855
8856 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8857
8858
8859stats enable
8860 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008862 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008863 Arguments : none
8864
8865 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8866 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8867 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8868 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8869 - stats auth : no authentication
8870 - stats scope : no restriction
8871
8872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8874 unobvious parameters.
8875
8876 Example :
8877 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8878 backend public_www
8879 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8880 stats enable
8881 stats hide-version
8882 stats scope .
8883 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008884 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008885 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8886 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8887
8888 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8889 backend private_monitoring
8890 stats enable
8891 stats uri /admin?stats
8892 stats refresh 5s
8893
8894 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8895
8896
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008897stats hide-version
8898 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008900 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008902
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008903 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8904 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8905 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8906 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8907 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8908 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008910 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8911 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8912 unobvious parameters.
8913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 Example :
8915 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8916 backend public_www
8917 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008918 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008919 stats hide-version
8920 stats scope .
8921 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008922 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008923 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8924 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008925
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008926 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8927 backend private_monitoring
8928 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008929 stats uri /admin?stats
8930 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008932 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008933
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008934
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008935stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8937 Access control for statistics
8938
8939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 no | no | yes | yes
8941
8942 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8943 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8944 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8945 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8946 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8947 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8948
8949 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8950 instance.
8951
8952 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8953 about ACL usage.
8954
8955
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008956stats realm <realm>
8957 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008960 Arguments :
8961 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8962 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8963 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8964
8965 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8966 using a backslash ('\').
8967
8968 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8969 only related to authentication.
8970
8971 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8972 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8973 unobvious parameters.
8974
8975 Example :
8976 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8977 backend public_www
8978 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8979 stats enable
8980 stats hide-version
8981 stats scope .
8982 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008983 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008984 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8985 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8986
8987 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8988 backend private_monitoring
8989 stats enable
8990 stats uri /admin?stats
8991 stats refresh 5s
8992
8993 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8994
8995
8996stats refresh <delay>
8997 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008999 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009000 Arguments :
9001 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9002 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9003 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9004 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9005 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9006 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9007
9008 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9009 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9010 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9011 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9012
9013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9015 unobvious parameters.
9016
9017 Example :
9018 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9019 backend public_www
9020 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9021 stats enable
9022 stats hide-version
9023 stats scope .
9024 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009025 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009026 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9027 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9028
9029 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9030 backend private_monitoring
9031 stats enable
9032 stats uri /admin?stats
9033 stats refresh 5s
9034
9035 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9036
9037
9038stats scope { <name> | "." }
9039 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009041 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009042 Arguments :
9043 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9044 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9045 section in which the statement appears.
9046
9047 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9048 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9049 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9050 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9051 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9052 exists.
9053
9054 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9055 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9056 unobvious parameters.
9057
9058 Example :
9059 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9060 backend public_www
9061 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9062 stats enable
9063 stats hide-version
9064 stats scope .
9065 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009067 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9068 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9069
9070 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9071 backend private_monitoring
9072 stats enable
9073 stats uri /admin?stats
9074 stats refresh 5s
9075
9076 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9077
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009078
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009079stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009080 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009082 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009083
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009084 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009085 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9086
9087 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9088 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9089
9090 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9091 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009092 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009093
9094 Example :
9095 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9096 backend private_monitoring
9097 stats enable
9098 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9099 stats uri /admin?stats
9100 stats refresh 5s
9101
9102 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9103 global section.
9104
9105
9106stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009107 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 yes | yes | yes | yes
9110 Arguments : none
9111
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009112 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009113 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9114 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9115 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9116 - IP (socket, server)
9117 - cookie (backend, server)
9118
9119 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9120 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009121 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009122
9123 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9124
9125
9126stats show-node [ <name> ]
9127 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009129 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009130 Arguments:
9131 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9132 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9133
9134 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9135 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009137
9138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9140 unobvious parameters.
9141
9142 Example:
9143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9144 backend private_monitoring
9145 stats enable
9146 stats show-node Europe-1
9147 stats uri /admin?stats
9148 stats refresh 5s
9149
9150 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9151 section.
9152
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009153
9154stats uri <prefix>
9155 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009157 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009158 Arguments :
9159 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9160 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9161 query string.
9162
9163 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9164 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9165 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9166 possible to reach it in the application.
9167
9168 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009169 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009170 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9171 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9172 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9173 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9174
9175 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9176 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9177 an address or a port to statistics only.
9178
9179 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9180 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9181 unobvious parameters.
9182
9183 Example :
9184 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9185 backend public_www
9186 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9187 stats enable
9188 stats hide-version
9189 stats scope .
9190 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009191 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009192 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9193 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9194
9195 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9196 backend private_monitoring
9197 stats enable
9198 stats uri /admin?stats
9199 stats refresh 5s
9200
9201 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9202
9203
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009204stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9205 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009207 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009208
9209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009210 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009211 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009212 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009213 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9214
9215 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9216 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9217 the "stick-table" statement.
9218
9219 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9220 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9221 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9222 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9223 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9224
9225 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9226 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9227 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9228 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9229 transformation rules.
9230
9231 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9232 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9233 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9234 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9235 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9236 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9237 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9238
9239 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9240 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9241 ACL based conditions.
9242
9243 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9244 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9245 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9246 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9247
9248 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9249 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9250 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9251 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9252
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009253 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9254 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009255 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009256
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009257 Example :
9258 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9259 # last 30 minutes
9260 backend pop
9261 mode tcp
9262 balance roundrobin
9263 stick store-request src
9264 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9265 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9266 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9267
9268 backend smtp
9269 mode tcp
9270 balance roundrobin
9271 stick match src table pop
9272 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9273 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9274
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009275 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009276 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009277
9278
9279stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9280 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9282 no | no | yes | yes
9283
9284 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9285 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9286 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9287 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9288
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009289 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9290 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009291 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009292
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009293 Examples :
9294 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009295 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009296
9297 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9298 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9299 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9300
9301
9302 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9303 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9304 backend http
9305 mode http
9306 balance roundrobin
9307 stick on src table https
9308 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9309 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9310 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9311
9312 backend https
9313 mode tcp
9314 balance roundrobin
9315 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9316 stick on src
9317 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9318 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9319
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009320 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009321
9322
9323stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9324 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 no | no | yes | yes
9327
9328 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009329 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009330 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009331 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009332 server is selected.
9333
9334 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9335 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9336 the "stick-table" statement.
9337
9338 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9339 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9340 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9341 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9342 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9343 address.
9344
9345 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9346 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9347 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9348 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9349 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9350 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9351 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9352 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9353 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9354 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9355
9356 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9357 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9358 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9359 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9360 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9361 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9362 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9363
9364 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9365 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9366 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9367 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9368
9369 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9370 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9371 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9372 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9373 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9374 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009375 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9376 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9377 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9378 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9379 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9380 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009381
9382 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9383 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9384 the request.
9385
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009386 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9387 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009388 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009389
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009390 Example :
9391 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9392 # last 30 minutes
9393 backend pop
9394 mode tcp
9395 balance roundrobin
9396 stick store-request src
9397 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9398 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9399 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9400
9401 backend smtp
9402 mode tcp
9403 balance roundrobin
9404 stick match src table pop
9405 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9406 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9407
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009408 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009409 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009410
9411
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009412stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009413 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9414 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009415 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009417 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009418
9419 Arguments :
9420 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9421 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9422 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9423 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9424
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009425 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9426 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9427 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9428 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009430 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9431 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9432 instance.
9433
9434 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9435 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9436 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9437 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9438 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9439 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009440 to 32 characters.
9441
9442 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9443 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9444 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009445 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009446 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9447 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009448
9449 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009450 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9451 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009452 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9453 increase.
9454
9455 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009456 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9457 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9458 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009459
9460 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9461 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9462 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9463 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009464 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009465 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9466 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9467 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9468 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9469 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9470 parameter (see below).
9471
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009472 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9473 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9474 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9475 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9476 soft restart.
9477
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009478 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9479 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009480
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009481 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9482 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9483 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9484 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009485 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009486 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009487 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9488 if not expiration delay is specified.
9489
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009490 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9491 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9492 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9493 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009494 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9495 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9496 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9497 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9498 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9499 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9500 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9501 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9502 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9503 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9504 types and their arguments.
9505
9506 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9507 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9508 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9509 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9510
9511 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9512 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9513 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009514 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009515
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009516 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9517 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9518 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009519 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009520 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009521 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009522
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009523 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9524 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9525 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9526 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9527
9528 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9529 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9530 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9531 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9532 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9533 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9534
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009535 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9536 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9537 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9538 they were received.
9539
9540 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9541 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9542 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9543 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9544 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9545
9546 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9547 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9548 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9549 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9550 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9551
9552 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9553 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9554 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9555
9556 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9557 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9558 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9559 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9560 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9561
9562 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9563 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9564 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9565 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9566 the client side.
9567
9568 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9569 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9570 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9571 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9572 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9573 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9574 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9575
9576 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9577 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9578 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9579 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9580 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9581 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009582 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009583
9584 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9585 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9586 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9587 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9588 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9589 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9590
9591 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009593 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9594 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9595
9596 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9597 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9598 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9599 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9600 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9601 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9602 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9603 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9604 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9605 recommended for better fairness.
9606
9607 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009609 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9610 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9611
9612 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9613 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9614 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9615 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9616 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9617 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9618 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9619 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9620 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9621 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009622
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009623 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9624 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009625 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9626 reference it.
9627
9628 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9629 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009630 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9631 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9632 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009633
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009634 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9635 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9636 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9637 something that can be ignored.
9638
9639 Example:
9640 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9641 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9642 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9643 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9644
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009645 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009646 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009647
9648
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009649stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009650 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9652 no | no | yes | yes
9653
9654 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009655 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009656 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009657 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009658 server is selected.
9659
9660 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9661 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9662 the "stick-table" statement.
9663
9664 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9665 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9666 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9667 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9668
9669 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9670 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9671 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9672 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9673 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9674 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009675 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009676 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9677 rules.
9678
9679 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9680 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9681 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9682 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9683 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9684 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9685 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9686
9687 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9688 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9689 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9690 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9691
9692 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9693 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9694 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9695 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9696 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9697 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009698 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9699 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9700 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9701 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9702 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9703 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9704 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9705 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9706 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009707
9708 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9709
9710 Example :
9711 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9712 backend https
9713 mode tcp
9714 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009715 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009716 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009717
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009718 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9719 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9720
9721 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9722 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9723 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9724
9725 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9726 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009727
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009728 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9729 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9730 # at offset 44.
9731
9732 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9733 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9734
9735 # Learn on response if server hello.
9736 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009737
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009738 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9739 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9740
9741 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9742 extraction.
9743
9744
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009745tcp-check connect [params*]
9746 Opens a new connection
9747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9748 no | no | yes | yes
9749
9750 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9751 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9752 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9753
9754 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9755 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9756 of the sequence.
9757
9758 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9759 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9760 do.
9761
9762 Parameters :
9763 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9764 use the TCP connection.
9765
9766 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9767 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9768 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9769
9770 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9771
9772 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9773
9774 Examples:
9775 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9776 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9777 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9778 option tcp-check
9779 tcp-check connect
9780 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9781 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9782 tcp-check send \r\n
9783 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9784 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9785 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9786 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9787 tcp-check send \r\n
9788 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9789 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9790
9791 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9792 option tcp-check
9793 tcp-check connect port 110
9794 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9795 tcp-check connect port 143
9796 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9797 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9798
9799 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9800
9801
9802tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009803 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9805 no | no | yes | yes
9806
9807 Arguments :
9808 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9809 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9810 binary.
9811 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9812 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9813 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9814
9815 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9816 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9817 with the usual backslash ('\').
9818 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009819 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009820 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9821 used upper or lower case.
9822
9823
9824 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9825
9826 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9827 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9828 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9829 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9830 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9831 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9832 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9833 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9834
9835 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9836 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9837 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9838 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9839 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9840 expression.
9841
9842 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9843 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9844 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9845 this exact hexadecimal string.
9846 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9847
9848 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9849 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9850 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9851 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9852 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9853 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9854 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9855 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9856 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9857 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9858 the null character.
9859
9860 Examples :
9861 # perform a POP check
9862 option tcp-check
9863 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9864
9865 # perform an IMAP check
9866 option tcp-check
9867 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9868
9869 # look for the redis master server
9870 option tcp-check
9871 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009872 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009873 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9874 tcp-check expect string role:master
9875 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9876 tcp-check expect string +OK
9877
9878
9879 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9880 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9881
9882
9883tcp-check send <data>
9884 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9886 no | no | yes | yes
9887
9888 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9889 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9890
9891 Examples :
9892 # look for the redis master server
9893 option tcp-check
9894 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9895 tcp-check expect string role:master
9896
9897 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9898 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9899
9900
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009901tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9902 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009903 tcp health check
9904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9905 no | no | yes | yes
9906
9907 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9908 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009910 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9911 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9912 hexadecimal string.
9913 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9914
9915 Examples :
9916 # redis check in binary
9917 option tcp-check
9918 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9919 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9920
9921
9922 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9923 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9924
9925
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009926tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9927 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9929 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009930 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009931 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9932 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009934 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009935
9936 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9937 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9939 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9940 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9941 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9942 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9943 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009945 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9946 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9947 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9948 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009949
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009950 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009951 - accept :
9952 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9953 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9954 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 - reject :
9957 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9958 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9959 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9960 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9961 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9962 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9963 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9964 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9965 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9966 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9967 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009968 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009969
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009970 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9971 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9972 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9973 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9974 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9975 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9976 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9977 hosts.
9978
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009979 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9980 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9981 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9982 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9983 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9984 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9985 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9986 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9987
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009988 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9989 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9990 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9991 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9992 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9993 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9994 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9995 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9996 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009997 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9998 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009999
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010000 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010001 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010002 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10003 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10004 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010005 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010006 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10007 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10008 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10009 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10010 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10011 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10012 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10013 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010015 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010016 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010017 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010018 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010019 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10020 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10021 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010023 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10024 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10025 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10026 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010028 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10029 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10030 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10031 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10032 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010033 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10034 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10035 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10036 layer7 information is extracted.
10037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010038 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10039 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10040 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10041 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10042 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010043
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010044 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10045 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10046 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10047 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10048
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010049 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10050 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10051 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10052 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10053
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010054 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10055 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10056 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10057 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10058 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010059
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010060 - set-src <expr> :
10061 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10062 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10063 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010064 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010066 Arguments:
10067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10068 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010069
10070 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010071 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10072
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010073 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10074 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010075
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010076 - set-src-port <expr> :
10077 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10078 expression.
10079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010080 Arguments:
10081 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10082 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010083
10084 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010085 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10086
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010087 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10088 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10089 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010090
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010091 - set-dst <expr> :
10092 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10093 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10094 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10095 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10096 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10097
10098 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10099 followed by some converters.
10100
10101 Example:
10102
10103 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10104 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10105
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010106 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10107 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10108
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010109 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10110 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10111 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10112 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10113
10114
10115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10116 followed by some converters.
10117
10118 Example:
10119
10120 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10121
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010122 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10123 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10124 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10125
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010126 - "silent-drop" :
10127 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010128 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010129 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10130 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10131 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10132 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10133 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010134 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10135 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010136 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10137 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010138 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010139 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10140 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10141 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10142 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010144 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10145 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10146 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010148 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10149 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10150 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010152 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010153 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010154 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010156 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10157 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10158 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010160 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010161 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10162 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010163
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010164 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10165
10166 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10167
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010168 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10169
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010170 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010171
10172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010173tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10174 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010176 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010178 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10179 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010181 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010183 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010184 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10185 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10186 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10187 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010189 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10190 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10191 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10192 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010193 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10194 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10195 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10196 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10197 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10198 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010199 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010200 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010201
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010202 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10203 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10204 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10205 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010206
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010207 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010208 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010209 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010210 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10211 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010212 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010213 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010214 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010215 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010216 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010217 - set-dst <expr>
10218 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010219 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010220 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010221 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010222 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010223 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010224
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010225 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10226 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010227 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10228 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010229
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010230 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10231 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10232 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10233 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10234 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10235 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010237 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010238 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10239 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010241 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010242 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10243 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10244 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10245 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010246 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10247 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10248 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010249
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010250 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010251 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10252 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10253 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010254
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010255 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10256 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10257
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010258 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010259 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10260 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010261
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010262 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10263 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10266 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010267 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010268 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010269 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10271 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010272 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010273 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10274 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010275
10276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10277 followed by some converters.
10278
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010279 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10280 <var-name>.
10281
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010282 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10283 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10284 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10285 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10286 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10287
10288 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10289 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10290 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10291 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10292 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10293 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10294 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10295 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10296 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10297 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10298 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10299
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010300 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10301 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10302 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10303 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10304 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10305
10306 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10307
10308 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10309
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010310 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10311 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10312 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10313 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10314 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10315 evaluated.
10316
10317 Example:
10318 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10319
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010320 Example:
10321
10322 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010323 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010324
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010325 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010326 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10327 # and reject everything else.
10328 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10329 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010330 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010331 tcp-request content reject
10332
10333 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010334 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10335 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10336 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010337 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010338
10339 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10340 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10341 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010342 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010343 tcp-request content reject
10344
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010345 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010346 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010347 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010348 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010349 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10350 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010351
10352 Example:
10353 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10354 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010355 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010357 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010358 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010359
10360 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010361 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010362 # protecting all our sites
10363 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010364 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10365 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010366 ...
10367 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10368
10369 backend http_dynamic
10370 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010371 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010372 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010373 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010374 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010375 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010376 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010378 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010379
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010380 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10381 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010382
10383
10384tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10385 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010387 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010388 Arguments :
10389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10391 as explained at the top of this document.
10392
10393 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10394 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10395 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10396 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10397 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10398
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010399 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10400 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10401 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10402 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10403
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010404 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10405 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010406 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010407 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010408 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10409 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10410 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10411 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010412
10413 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10414 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10415 it pass through unaffected.
10416
10417 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10418 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10419 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010420 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010421 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10422 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010423 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10424 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10425 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010426
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010427 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010428 "timeout client".
10429
10430
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010431tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10432 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10434 no | no | yes | yes
10435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010436 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10437 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010438
10439 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10440
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010442 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10443 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010444 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10445 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010446
10447 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10448
10449 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10450 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10451 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10452 inserted.
10453
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010454 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010455 - accept :
10456 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10457 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10458 the rules evaluation.
10459
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010460 - close :
10461 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10462 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10463 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10464 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10465 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10466 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010467 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010468 protocols.
10469
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010470 - reject :
10471 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10472 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010473 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010474
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010475 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10476 Sets a variable.
10477
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010478 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10479 Unsets a variable.
10480
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010481 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10482 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10483 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10484 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10485
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010486 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10487 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10488 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10489 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10490
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010491 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10492 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10493 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10494 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10495 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010496
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010497 - "silent-drop" :
10498 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010499 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010500 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10501 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10502 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10503 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10504 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010505 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10506 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010507 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10508 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010509 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010510 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10511 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10512 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10513 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10514
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010515 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10516 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10517
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010518 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10519 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10520 for changing the default action to a reject.
10521
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010522 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10523 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10524 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10525 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010526 period.
10527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010528 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10529 declared inline.
10530
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010531 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10532 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10535 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010536 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010537 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010538 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010539 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10540 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010541 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010542 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10543 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010544
10545 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10546 followed by some converters.
10547
10548 Example:
10549
10550 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10551
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010552 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10553 <var-name>.
10554
10555 Example:
10556
10557 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10558
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010559 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10560 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10561 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10562 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10563 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10564
10565 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10566
10567 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10568
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010569 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10570
10571 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10572
10573
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010574tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10575 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10577 no | yes | yes | no
10578 Arguments :
10579 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10580 below.
10581
10582 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10583
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010584 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010585 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10586 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10587 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10588 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10589 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10590 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10591 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010592 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010593 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10594 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10595 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10596 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10597 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10598 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10599 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10600 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10601 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10602 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10603 instead.
10604
10605 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10606 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10607 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10608 rules which may be inserted.
10609
10610 Several types of actions are supported :
10611 - accept : the request is accepted
10612 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10613 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10614 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010615 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010616 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010617 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010618 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010619 - silent-drop
10620
10621 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10622 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10623 sections for a complete description.
10624
10625 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10626 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10627 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10628
10629 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10630 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10631 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10632 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10633 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10634
10635 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10636 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10637
10638 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10639 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10640 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10641
10642 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10643 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10644 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10645
10646 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10647 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10648 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10649
10650 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10651 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10652 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10653
10654 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10655
10656 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10657
10658
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010659tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10660 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10662 no | no | yes | yes
10663 Arguments :
10664 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10665 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10666 as explained at the top of this document.
10667
10668 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10669
10670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010671timeout check <timeout>
10672 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10673 established.
10674
10675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10676 yes | no | yes | yes
10677 Arguments:
10678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10680 as explained at the top of this document.
10681
10682 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10683 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010684 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010685 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010686 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10687 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10688 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010689
10690 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10691 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10692
10693 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10694 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010695 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010696
10697 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10698 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10699 forget about it.
10700
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010701 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10702 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010703
10704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010705timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010706 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10708 yes | yes | yes | no
10709 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010710 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010711 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10712 as explained at the top of this document.
10713
10714 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10715 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10716 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010717 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10718 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10719 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10720 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010721 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10722 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10723 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010724 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010725 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10727 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010728 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10729 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010730
10731 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10732 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10733 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10734 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010735 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010736 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10737
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010738 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010739
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010740 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010742
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010743timeout client-fin <timeout>
10744 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10746 yes | yes | yes | no
10747 Arguments :
10748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10750 as explained at the top of this document.
10751
10752 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10753 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10754 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10755 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10756 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10757 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10758 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010759 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10760 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10761 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010762
10763 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10764 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10765 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10766
10767 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10768
10769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010770timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010771 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10773 yes | no | yes | yes
10774 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10777 as explained at the top of this document.
10778
10779 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010780 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010781 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010782 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010783 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10784 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010785
10786 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010790 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10792
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010793 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010795
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010796timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10797 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10799 yes | yes | yes | yes
10800 Arguments :
10801 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10802 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10803 as explained at the top of this document.
10804
10805 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10806 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10807 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10808 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10809 once the request has started to present itself.
10810
10811 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10812 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10813 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10814 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10815 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10816
10817 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10818 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10819 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10820 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10821
10822 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10823 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010824 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010825 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10826 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010827 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010828
10829 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10830 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10831 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10832 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10833
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010834 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10835 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010836 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10837
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010838 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10839
10840
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010841timeout http-request <timeout>
10842 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010844 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10848 as explained at the top of this document.
10849
10850 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10851 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10852 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10853 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10854 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10855 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10856 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010857 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10858 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10859 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10860 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010861 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010862 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10863 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010864
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010865 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10866 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10867 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10868 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10869 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010870 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010871
10872 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10873 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010874 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010875 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10876 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10877
10878 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010879 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10880 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10881 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010882
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010883 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010884 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010885
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010886
10887timeout queue <timeout>
10888 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10890 yes | no | yes | yes
10891 Arguments :
10892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10894 as explained at the top of this document.
10895
10896 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10897 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10898 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10899 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10900 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10901
10902 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10903 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10904 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10905 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10906
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010907 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010908
10909
10910timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010911 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10913 yes | no | yes | yes
10914 Arguments :
10915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10917 as explained at the top of this document.
10918
10919 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10920 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10921 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10922 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10923 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10924 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10925 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10926
10927 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10928 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10929 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10930 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10931 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010932 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010933 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10935 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010936 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10937 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010938
10939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10940 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10941 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10942 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010943 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010944 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10945
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010946 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010947
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010948
10949timeout server-fin <timeout>
10950 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10952 yes | no | yes | yes
10953 Arguments :
10954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10956 as explained at the top of this document.
10957
10958 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10959 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10960 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10961 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10962 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10963 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10964 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10965 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10966 situations, it should not be needed.
10967
10968 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10969 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10970 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10971
10972 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10973
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010974
10975timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010976 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10978 yes | yes | yes | yes
10979 Arguments :
10980 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10981 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10982 as explained at the top of this document.
10983
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010984 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10985 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10986 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010987
10988 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10989 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10990 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10991 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010992 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010993
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010994 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010995
10996
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010997timeout tunnel <timeout>
10998 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11000 yes | no | yes | yes
11001 Arguments :
11002 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11003 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11004 as explained at the top of this document.
11005
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011006 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011007 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11008 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11009 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11011 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011012 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11013 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11014 specified.
11015
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011016 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11017 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11018 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11019 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11020 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11021 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11022 state.
11023
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011024 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11025 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11026 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11027 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011028 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011029
11030 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11031 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11032 forget about it.
11033
11034 Example :
11035 defaults http
11036 option http-server-close
11037 timeout connect 5s
11038 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011039 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011040 timeout server 30s
11041 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11042
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011043 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011044
11045
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011046transparent (deprecated)
11047 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011049 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011050 Arguments : none
11051
11052 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11053 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11054 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11055 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11056 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11057 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11058 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11059 appropriate server.
11060
11061 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11062
11063 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11064 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11065
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011066 See also: "option transparent"
11067
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011068unique-id-format <string>
11069 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11071 yes | yes | yes | no
11072 Arguments :
11073 <string> is a log-format string.
11074
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011075 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11076 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11077 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11078 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011079
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011080 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11081 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11082 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11083 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11084 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11085 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11086 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11087 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011088
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011089 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11090 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011091
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011092 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011093
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011094 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011095
11096 will generate:
11097
11098 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11099
11100 See also: "unique-id-header"
11101
11102unique-id-header <name>
11103 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11105 yes | yes | yes | no
11106 Arguments :
11107 <name> is the name of the header.
11108
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011109 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11110 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011111
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011112 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011113
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011114 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011115 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11116
11117 will generate:
11118
11119 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11120
11121 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011122
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011123use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011124 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11126 no | yes | yes | no
11127 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011128 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11129 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011130
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011131 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11132 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011133
11134 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11135 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11136 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011137 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011138 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011139 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11140 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011141
11142 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11143 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11144 assign the backend.
11145
11146 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11147 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11148 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11149 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11150 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11151 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11152
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011153 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011154 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011155 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11156 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11157 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11158
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011159 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11160 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11161 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11162 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11163 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11164 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11165 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11166 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11167 cannot be forced from the request.
11168
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011169 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011170 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11171 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11172
11173 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11174 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011175
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011176use-fcgi-app <name>
11177 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11179 no | no | yes | yes
11180 Arguments :
11181 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11182
11183 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011184
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011185use-server <server> if <condition>
11186use-server <server> unless <condition>
11187 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11189 no | no | yes | yes
11190 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011191 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11192 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011193
11194 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11195
11196 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11197 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11198 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11199
11200 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11201 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11202 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11203 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11204 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11205 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11206 matches will assign the server.
11207
11208 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11209 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11210 with the next rules until one matches.
11211
11212 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11213 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11214 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11215 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11216
11217 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11218 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11219 stripped.
11220
11221 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11222 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11223 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11224 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11225
11226 Example :
11227 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11228 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11229 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11230 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11231 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11232 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011233 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011234 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11235 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11236
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011237 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11238 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11239 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11240 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11241 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11242 and we fall back to load balancing.
11243
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011244 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011245
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011246
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112475. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248--------------------------
11249
11250The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11251depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11252settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11253written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11254described in this section.
11255
11256
112575.1. Bind options
11258-----------------
11259
11260The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11261as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11262no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11263parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11264while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11265provided immediately after the setting name.
11266
11267The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11268
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011269accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11270 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11271 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11272 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11273 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11274 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11275 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11276 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11277 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11278 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011279 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11280 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11281 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011283accept-proxy
11284 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011285 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11286 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011287 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11288 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11289 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11290 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011291 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011292 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11293 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011294 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11295 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011296
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011297allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011298 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011299 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011300 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011301 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11302 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011303
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011304alpn <protocols>
11305 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11306 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11307 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011308 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011309 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011310 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11311 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11312 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11313 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11314 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11315 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11316 preference, like below :
11317
11318 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011319
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011320backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011321 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011322 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11323
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011324curves <curves>
11325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11326 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11327 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11328 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11329 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11330 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11331
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011332ecdhe <named curve>
11333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011334 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11335 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011336
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011337ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11339 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11340 client's certificate.
11341
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011342ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11344 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11345 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11346 error is ignored.
11347
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011348ca-sign-file <cafile>
11349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11350 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11351 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11352 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11353 'generate-certificates' for details.
11354
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011355ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11357 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11358 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11359 'generate-certificates' for details.
11360
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011361ca-verify-file <cafile>
11362 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11363 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11364 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11365 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11366 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011368ciphers <ciphers>
11369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11370 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011371 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011372 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011373 information and recommendations see e.g.
11374 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11375 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11376 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11377
11378ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11380 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11381 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11382 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011383 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11384 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011385
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011386crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11388 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11389 to verify client's certificate.
11390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011391crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11393 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11394 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11395 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11396 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011397 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11398 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011399
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011400 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11401 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11402
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011403 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11404 are loaded.
11405
11406 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011407 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11408 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11409 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11410 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11411 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11412 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11413 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011414 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011415
11416 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11417 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11418 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11419 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011420 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11421 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011422
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011423 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011424
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011425 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011426 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011427 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11428 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011429 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11430 clients).
11431
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011432 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11433 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11434 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11435 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11436 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11437 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11438 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11439 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11440 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11441 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11442 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11443 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11444 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11445
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011446 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11447 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11448 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11449 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11450 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11451
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011452 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11453 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11454 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11455 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011456
11457 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11458 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11459 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11460 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11461 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11462 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11463 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11464 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11465 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11466
11467 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11468
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011469 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011470 a cert bundle.
11471
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011472 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011473 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11474 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11475 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11476 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11477 provide multi-cert support.
11478
11479 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11480
11481 Filename | CN | SAN
11482 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11483 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011484 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011485 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11486 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11487
11488 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11489 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11490 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11491 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011492 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11493 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11494 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011495
11496 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11497 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11498
11499 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11500 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11501 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11502
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011503crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011506 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011507 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011508
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011509crt-list <file>
11510 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011511 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11512 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011513
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011514 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11515
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011516 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11517 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11518 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11519 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011520
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011521 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11522 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11523 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11524 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11525 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11526 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11527 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11528 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011529
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011530 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011531 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011532 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11533 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11534 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011535
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011536 crt-list file example:
11537 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011538 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011539 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011540 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011541
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011542defer-accept
11543 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11544 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11545 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011546 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011547 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11548 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11549 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11550 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11551 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11552 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11553 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11554
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011555expose-fd listeners
11556 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11557 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011558 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11559 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011561
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011562force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011563 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011564 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011565 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011566 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011567
11568force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011569 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011570 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011571 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011572
11573force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011574 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011575 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011576 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011577
11578force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011579 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011580 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011581 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011582
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011583force-tlsv13
11584 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11585 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011586 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011587
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011588generate-certificates
11589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11590 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11591 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11592 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11593 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11594 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11595 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11596 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11597 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11598 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11599 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11600
11601 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11602 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011603 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011604 certificate is used many times.
11605
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011606gid <gid>
11607 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11608 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11609 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11610 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11611 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11612
11613group <group>
11614 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11615 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11616 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11617 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11618 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11619
11620id <id>
11621 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11622 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11623 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11624 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11625
11626interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011627 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11628 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11629 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11630 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11631 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11632 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011633 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11634 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11635 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11636 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11637 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11638 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011639
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011640level <level>
11641 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11642 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11643 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011644 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011645 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11646 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11647 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011648 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011649 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011650 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011651 all counters).
11652
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011653severity-output <format>
11654 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11655 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11656 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11657 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11658 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11659 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11660 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11661 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11662 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11663 rfc5424 convention.
11664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011665maxconn <maxconn>
11666 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11667 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11668 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11669 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11670 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11671 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11672 eat all memory.
11673
11674mode <mode>
11675 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11676 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11677 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11678 UNIX sockets.
11679
11680mss <maxseg>
11681 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11682 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11683 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11684 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11685 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11686 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11687 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11688 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11689 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11690 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11691 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11692
11693name <name>
11694 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11695 page.
11696
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011697namespace <name>
11698 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11699 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11700 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11701 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11702
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011703nice <nice>
11704 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11705 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11706 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11707 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11708 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11709 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11710 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11711 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11712 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11713 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11714 one for an RDP socket.
11715
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011716no-ca-names
11717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11718 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011719 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011720
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011721no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011723 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011724 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011725 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011726 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11727 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011728
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011729no-tls-tickets
11730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11731 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11732 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11734 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011735 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11736 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11737 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011738
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011739no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011741 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011742 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011743 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011744 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11745 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011746
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011747no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011749 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011750 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011751 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011752 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11753 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011754
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011755no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011757 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011758 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011759 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011760 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11761 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011762
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011763no-tlsv13
11764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11765 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11766 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11767 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11769 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011770
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011771npn <protocols>
11772 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11773 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11774 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011775 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011776 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011777 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11778 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11779 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11780 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11781 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011782
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011783prefer-client-ciphers
11784 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11785 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11786 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011787 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11788 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11789 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011790
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011791process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011792 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011793 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011794 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011795 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11796 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11797 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11798 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011799 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011800 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11801 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11802 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11803 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11804 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011805
11806 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11807
11808 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11809 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11810 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11811 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11812 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11813 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11814 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11815 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011816
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011817proto <name>
11818 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11819 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11820 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11821 in haproxy -vv.
11822 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11823 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011824 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011825 h2" on the bind line.
11826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011827ssl
11828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011829 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011830 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11831 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011832 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11833 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011834
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011835ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11836 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11837 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11838 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11839
11840ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11841 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11842 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11843 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11844
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011845strict-sni
11846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11847 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11848 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11849 See the "crt" option for more information.
11850
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011851tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011852 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011853 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11854 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011855 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011856 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11857 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11858 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11859 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11860 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11861 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11862 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11863
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011864tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011865 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011866 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11867 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11868 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11869 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11870 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11871 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11872 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011873 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11874 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11875 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011876
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011877tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11878 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011879 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11880 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11881 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11882 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11883 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11884 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11885 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11886 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11887 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11888 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011889 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11890 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11891
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011892transparent
11893 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11894 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11895 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11896 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11897 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11898 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11899 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11900 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11901 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11902 so check for support with your vendor.
11903
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011904v4v6
11905 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11906 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11907 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11908 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011909 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011910
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011911v6only
11912 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11913 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11914 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011915 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11916 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011917
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011918uid <uid>
11919 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11920 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11921 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11922 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11923 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11924
11925user <user>
11926 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11927 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11928 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11929 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11930 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11931
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011932verify [none|optional|required]
11933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11934 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11935 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11936 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11937 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011938 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11939 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11940 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11941 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119435.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011944------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011946The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11947which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11948arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11949settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11950after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11951Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11952address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011954 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011955 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011956
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011957Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11958keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011960The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011961
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011962addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011963 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011964 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11965 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11966 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11967 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11968 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011969
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011970agent-check
11971 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011972 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011973 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11974 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11975 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011976
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011977 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011978 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011979 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11980 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11981 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011982
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011983 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11984 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11985 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11986 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11987 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011988
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011989 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011990 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011991
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011992 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11993 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11994 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011995
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011996 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11997 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11998 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011999
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012000 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12001 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12002 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12003 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12004 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012005 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012006 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012007
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012008 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12009 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012010
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012011 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12012 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12013 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12014 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12015 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12016 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12017 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12018 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12019 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012020
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012021 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12022 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012023 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12024 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12025 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012026 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012027
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012028 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012029 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012030
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012031agent-send <string>
12032 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12033 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12034 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12035 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12036 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12037
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012038agent-inter <delay>
12039 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12040 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12041
12042 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12043 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12044 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12045 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12046 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12047 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12048 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12049 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12050 of backends use the same servers.
12051
12052 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12053
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012054agent-addr <addr>
12055 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12056
12057 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12058 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12059 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12060 hostname, it will be resolved.
12061
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012062agent-port <port>
12063 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12064
12065 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12066
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012067allow-0rtt
12068 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012069 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12070 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012071
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012072alpn <protocols>
12073 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12074 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12075 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012076 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012077 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12078 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12079 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12080 now obsolete NPN extension.
12081 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12082 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12083
12084 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012086backup
12087 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12088 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12089 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12090 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012091 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12092 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012093
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012094ca-file <cafile>
12095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12096 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12097 server's certificate.
12098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012099check
12100 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012101 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12102 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12103 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12104 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12105 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12106 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12107 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012108 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12109 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012110 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12111 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012112
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012113check-send-proxy
12114 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12115 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12116 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12117 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12118 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12119 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12120 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12121
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012122check-alpn <protocols>
12123 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12124 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12125 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12126
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012127check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012128 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012129 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12130 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012131
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012132check-ssl
12133 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12134 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12135 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12136 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012137 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012138 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12139 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012140 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012141 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12142 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012143
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012144check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012145 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012146 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12147 for normal traffic.
12148
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012149ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12151 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12152 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012153 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12154 information and recommendations see e.g.
12155 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12156 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12157 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012158
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012159ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12161 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12162 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12163 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12165 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12166 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012168cookie <value>
12169 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12170 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12171 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12172 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12173 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12174 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12175 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12176
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012177crl-file <crlfile>
12178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12179 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12180 to verify server's certificate.
12181
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012182crt <cert>
12183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12184 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12185 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12186 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12187 certificate request.
12188
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012189disabled
12190 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12191 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12192 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12193 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12194 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012195 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012196
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012197enabled
12198 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12199 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12200 default value.
12201 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12202 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012204error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012205 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12206 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12207 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012209 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012211fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012212 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12213 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12214 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12215
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012216force-sslv3
12217 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12218 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012219 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012220 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012221
12222force-tlsv10
12223 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012224 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012225 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012226
12227force-tlsv11
12228 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012229 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012230 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012231
12232force-tlsv12
12233 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012234 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012235 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012236
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012237force-tlsv13
12238 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12239 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012240 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012242id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012243 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12244 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12245 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012246
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012247init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12248 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12249 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012250 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012251 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12252 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12253 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12254 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12255 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12256 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12257 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12258 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12259 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012261 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12262 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12263 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12264 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12265 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12266 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012268
12269 Example:
12270 defaults
12271 # never fail on address resolution
12272 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012274inter <delay>
12275fastinter <delay>
12276downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012277 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12278 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12279 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12280 between checks depending on the server state :
12281
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012282 Server state | Interval used
12283 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12284 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12285 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12286 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12287 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12288 or yet unchecked. |
12289 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12290 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12291 | "inter" otherwise.
12292 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012294 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12295 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12296 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12297 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012298 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12299 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12300 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12301 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12302 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012304maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012305 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12306 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012307 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12308 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012309 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12310 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12311 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12312 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12313
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012314 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12315 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12316 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12317 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12318 than 50 concurrent requests.
12319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012320maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012321 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12322 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12323 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12324 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12325 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12326 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12327 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12328
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012329max-reuse <count>
12330 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12331 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12332 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12333 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12334 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12335 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12336 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12337 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012339minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012340 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12341 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12342 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12343 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12344 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12345 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012346 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012347 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012348
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012349namespace <name>
12350 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12351 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12352 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12353 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12354
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012355no-agent-check
12356 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12357 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12358 default value.
12359 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12360 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12361
12362no-backup
12363 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12364 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12365 default value.
12366 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12367 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12368
12369no-check
12370 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12371 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12372 default value.
12373 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12374 "default-server" "check" setting.
12375
12376no-check-ssl
12377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12379 default value.
12380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12381 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12382
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012383no-send-proxy
12384 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12385 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12386 default value.
12387 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12388 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12389
12390no-send-proxy-v2
12391 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12392 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12393 default value.
12394 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12395 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12396
12397no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12398 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12399 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12400 default value.
12401 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12402 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12403
12404no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12405 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12406 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12407 default value.
12408 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12409 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12410
12411no-ssl
12412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12414 default value.
12415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12416 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12417
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012418no-ssl-reuse
12419 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12420 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12421 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12422 and for paranoid users.
12423
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012424no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012425 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12426 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012427 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012428
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012429 Supported in default-server: No
12430
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012431no-tls-tickets
12432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12433 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12434 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012435 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12436 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012437 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12438 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12439 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012440 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012442no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012443 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012444 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12445 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012446 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12447 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012448 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012449
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012450 Supported in default-server: No
12451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012452no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012453 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012454 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12455 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012456 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12457 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012458 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012459
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012460 Supported in default-server: No
12461
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012462no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012463 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012464 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12465 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012466 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12467 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012468 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012469
12470 Supported in default-server: No
12471
12472no-tlsv13
12473 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12474 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12475 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12476 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12477 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012478 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012479
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012480 Supported in default-server: No
12481
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012482no-verifyhost
12483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12485 default value.
12486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12487 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012488
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012489no-tfo
12490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12492 default value.
12493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12494 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12495
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012496non-stick
12497 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12498 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12499 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12500
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012501npn <protocols>
12502 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12503 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12504 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012505 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012506 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12507 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12508 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012510observe <mode>
12511 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12512 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12513 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12514 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12515 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12516 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012517 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012518
12519 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012521on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012522 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12523 Currently, four modes are available:
12524 - fastinter: force fastinter
12525 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12526 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12527 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12528 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12529
12530 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12531
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012532on-marked-down <action>
12533 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12534 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012535 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12536 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12537 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12538 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12539 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12540 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12541 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12542 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012543
12544 Actions are disabled by default
12545
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012546on-marked-up <action>
12547 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12548 Currently one action is available:
12549 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12550 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12551 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12552 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12554 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012555 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12556 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12557
12558 Actions are disabled by default
12559
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012560pool-max-conn <max>
12561 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12562 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12563 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12564 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12565 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12566 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12567
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012568pool-purge-delay <delay>
12569 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012570 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012571 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012573port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012574 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12575 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12576 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12577 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12578 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12579 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12580
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012581proto <name>
12582
12583 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12584 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12585 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12586 reported in haproxy -vv.
12587 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12588 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012590redir <prefix>
12591 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12592 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12593 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12594 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12595 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12596 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12597 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12598 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012599 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012600 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012601 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12602 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12603 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12604 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12605
12606 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012608rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012609 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12610 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12611 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12612
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012613resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12614 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12615 server.
12616
12617 Available options:
12618
12619 * allow-dup-ip
12620 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12621 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12622 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12623 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12624 For such case, simply enable this option.
12625 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12626
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012627 * ignore-weight
12628 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12629 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12630 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12631
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012632 * prevent-dup-ip
12633 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12634 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12635 same fqdn.
12636 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12637
12638 Example:
12639 backend b_myapp
12640 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12641 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12642 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12643
12644 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12645 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12646 it
12647 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12648 different address
12649
12650 Default value: not set
12651
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012652resolve-prefer <family>
12653 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12654 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12655 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12656 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12657
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012658 Default value: ipv6
12659
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012660 Example:
12661
12662 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012663
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012664resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012665 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012666 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012667 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12669 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012670 configured network, another address is selected.
12671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012672 Example:
12673
12674 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012675
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012676resolvers <id>
12677 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12678 hostname.
12679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012680 Example:
12681
12682 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012684 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012685
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012686send-proxy
12687 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12688 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12689 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12690 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012691 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12692 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12693 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12694 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12695 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12696 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12697 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12698 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12699 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12700 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012701 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12702 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012703
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012704send-proxy-v2
12705 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12706 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12707 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12708 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012709 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12710 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12711 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12712 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012713
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012714proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012715 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12716 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12717
12718 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12719 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12720 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12721 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12722 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12723 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12724 connection is supported).
12725 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12726 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12727 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12728 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12729 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12730 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12731 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012732
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012733send-proxy-v2-ssl
12734 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12735 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12736 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12737 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12738 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12739 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12740 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012741 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12742 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012743
12744send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12745 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12746 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12747 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12748 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12749 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12750 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12751 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12752 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012753 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12754 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012756slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012757 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12758 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12759 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12760 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12761 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12762 parameters :
12763
12764 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12765 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12766
12767 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12768 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12769 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12770 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12771
12772 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12773 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12774 seen as failed.
12775
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012776sni <expression>
12777 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12778 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12779 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12780 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012781 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12782 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012783 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012784 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12785 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012786
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012787source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012788source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012789source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012790 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12791 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12792 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12793 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12794
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012795 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12796 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12797 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12798 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12799 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12800 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12801 server.
12802
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012803 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12804 specifying the source address without port(s).
12805
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012806ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012807 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12808 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12809 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12810 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12811 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12812 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012813 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12814 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012815
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012816ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12817 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12818 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12819 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12820
12821ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12822 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12823 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12824 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12825
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012826ssl-reuse
12827 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12828 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12829 default value.
12830 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12831 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12832
12833stick
12834 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12835 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12836 default value.
12837 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12838 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012839
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012840socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012841 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012842 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12843 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12844
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012845tcp-ut <delay>
12846 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12847 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12848 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012849 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012850 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12851 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12852 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12853 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12854 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12855 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12856 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12857 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12858 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12859
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012860tfo
12861 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12862 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12863 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12864 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12865 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012866 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012868track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012869 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12870 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12871 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12872 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012873 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12874
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012875tls-tickets
12876 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12877 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12878 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012879 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12880 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12881 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012882 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012883 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012884
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012885verify [none|required]
12886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012887 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012888 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12889 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012890 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012891 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12892 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12893 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12894 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12895 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12896 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12897 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12898 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012899
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012900verifyhost <hostname>
12901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012902 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12903 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12904 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12905 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12906 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12907 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12908 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12909 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012911weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012912 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12913 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12914 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012915 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12916 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12917 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12918 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12919 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12920 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012921
12922
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129235.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12924-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012925
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012926HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12927using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12928configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012929This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12930can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12931workload.
12932This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12933resolution at run time.
12934Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12935carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12936
12937
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129385.3.1. Global overview
12939----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012940
12941As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12942different steps of the process life:
12943
12944 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12945 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12946 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12947
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012948 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12949 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012950
12951A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12952 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12953 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12954 resolution to know this new IP.
12955
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012956When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012957HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012958SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12959from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12960will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12961will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012962
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012963A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012964 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012965 first valid response.
12966
12967 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12968 servers return an error.
12969
12970
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129715.3.2. The resolvers section
12972----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012973
12974This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012975HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12976contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012977
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012978When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12979uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12980is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12981answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12982
12983When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012984used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012985
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012986 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12987 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12988 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012989
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012990 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12991 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012992
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012993 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12994 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12995 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012996
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012997For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12998following scenarios are possible:
12999
13000 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13001 ignored
13002
13003 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13004 applied
13005
13006 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13007 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13008
13009 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13010 retries the query with a new type
13011
13012 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13013 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013014
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013015As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13016a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013017<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013018
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013019
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013020resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013021 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013022
13023A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13024
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013025accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013027 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013028 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13029 by RFC 6891)
13030
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013031 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13032
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013033nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13034 DNS server description:
13035 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13036 <ip> : IP address of the server
13037 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13038
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013039parse-resolv-conf
13040 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13041 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13042 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13043
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013044hold <status> <period>
13045 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13046 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013047 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013048 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013049 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13050 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13051 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13052
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013053 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013054
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013055resolve_retries <nb>
13056 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13057 giving up.
13058 Default value: 3
13059
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013060 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13061 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13062 type.
13063
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013064timeout <event> <time>
13065 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13066 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13067 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013068 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13069 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013070 Default value: 1s
13071 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013072 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013073 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013074 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13075 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13076
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013077 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013078
13079 resolvers mydns
13080 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13081 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013082 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013083 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013084 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013085 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013086 hold other 30s
13087 hold refused 30s
13088 hold nx 30s
13089 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013090 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013091 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013092
13093
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200130946. Cache
13095---------
13096
13097HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13098(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13099RAM.
13100
13101The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13102this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13103
13104If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13105independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13106when we try to allocate a new one.
13107
13108The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13109
13110It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13111"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13112for more details.
13113
13114When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13115replaced by "<CACHE>".
13116
13117
131186.1. Limitation
13119----------------
13120
13121The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13122
13123- If the response is not a 200
13124- If the response contains a Vary header
13125- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13126- If the response is not cacheable
13127
13128- If the request is not a GET
13129- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13130- If the request contains an Authorization header
13131
13132
131336.2. Setup
13134-----------
13135
13136To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13137the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13138
13139
131406.2.1. Cache section
13141---------------------
13142
13143cache <name>
13144 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13145 size of cache is mandatory.
13146
13147total-max-size <megabytes>
13148 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13149 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13150
13151max-object-size <bytes>
13152 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13153 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13154 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13155
13156max-age <seconds>
13157 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13158 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13159 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13160 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13161 default.
13162
13163
131646.2.2. Proxy section
13165---------------------
13166
13167http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13168 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13169 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13170 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13171 after this one.
13172
13173http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13174 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13175 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13176 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13177 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13178
13179
13180Example:
13181
13182 backend bck1
13183 mode http
13184
13185 http-request cache-use foobar
13186 http-response cache-store foobar
13187 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13188
13189 cache foobar
13190 total-max-size 4
13191 max-age 240
13192
13193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131947. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13195----------------------------------
13196
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013197HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13199The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13200these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13201but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13202data called patterns.
13203
13204
132057.1. ACL basics
13206---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013207
13208The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13209content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13210from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13211simple :
13212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013214 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13216 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13219adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013220
13221In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013224
13225This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13226Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13227and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013228an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13229conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13230as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13231are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013232
13233ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13234'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13235which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13236
13237There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13238performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13241specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13242this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013243methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13244ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245
13246Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13247 - boolean
13248 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13249 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13250 - string
13251 - data block
13252
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013253Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13254converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13255would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13256The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13257which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13258
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013259Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13260keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13261fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13262which are summarized in the table below :
13263
13264 +---------------------+-----------------+
13265 | Sample or converter | Default |
13266 | output type | matching method |
13267 +---------------------+-----------------+
13268 | boolean | bool |
13269 +---------------------+-----------------+
13270 | integer | int |
13271 +---------------------+-----------------+
13272 | ip | ip |
13273 +---------------------+-----------------+
13274 | string | str |
13275 +---------------------+-----------------+
13276 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13277 +---------------------+-----------------+
13278
13279Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13280matching method, see below.
13281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13283 - boolean
13284 - integer or integer range
13285 - IP address / network
13286 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13287 - regular expression
13288 - hex block
13289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013290The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13291
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013292 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13293 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013295 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013296 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013297 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013298 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013300The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13301read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13302if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13303lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13304will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13305beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13306a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13307lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13308exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13309
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013310The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13311parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13312ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13313a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13314check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13315
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013316The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13317socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13318file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13321loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13322
13323 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13324
13325In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13326the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13327case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13328as well.
13329
13330The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13331sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13332do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13333methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13334is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013335obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13337default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13338that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13339string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13340
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013341The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13342By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13343string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13344resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13345server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013346waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013347flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13348function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13351sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13352be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013353
13354 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13355 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13357 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13358 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13359 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013360
13361 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13362 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013363 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013364
13365 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013367
13368 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013371 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013372 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13373
13374 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13375 binary or string samples.
13376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13378 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13381 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13382 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013384 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13385 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013387 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13388 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13391 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13394 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013395 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013397 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13398 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13399 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013400
13401For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13402request, it is possible to do :
13403
13404 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13405
13406In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13407buffer, one would use the following acl :
13408
13409 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13410
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013411On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13412possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13413
13414 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013416All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13417criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13418method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13419to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13420criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13421the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013424the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13425For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13428 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13429 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13430 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013431
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013432
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013433The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13434types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13435combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13436brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13437default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 +-------------------------------------------------+
13440 | Input sample type |
13441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013442 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13444 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013446 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013448 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013450 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013452 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013454 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013456 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013458 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013460 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013462 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013464 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013466 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13468 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13469 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013470
13471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134727.1.1. Matching booleans
13473------------------------
13474
13475In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13476Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13477When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13478that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13479
13480Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13481return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13482"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134857.1.2. Matching integers
13486------------------------
13487
13488Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13489enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13490to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13491
13492Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13493matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13494lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013495
13496For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13497unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13498representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13499
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013500As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13501two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13502instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13503ranges and operators.
13504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013505For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013506operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13507Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13508of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013510Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013511
13512 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13513 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13514 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13515 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13516 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013518For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013519
13520 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13521
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013522This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13523
13524 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135277.1.3. Matching strings
13528-----------------------
13529
13530String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13531different forms :
13532
13533 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535
13536 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013537 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013538
13539 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13540 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13541
13542 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13543 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13544
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013545 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13547 matches.
13548
13549 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13550 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13551 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013552
13553String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13554exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13555characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13556string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13557to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013558before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013559
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013560Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13561(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13562Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13563
13564Example:
13565 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13566 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13570---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013571
13572Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13573they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13574possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13575passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13576the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013577the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13578match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013579
13580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13582-------------------------------------
13583
13584It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13585not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13586a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13587to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13588digits may be used upper or lower case.
13589
13590Example :
13591 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13592 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13593
13594
135957.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13596---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013597
13598IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13599netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13600within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013601host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013602difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13603at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13604does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13605parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013606
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013607The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13608abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13609
13610 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13611 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13612 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13613 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13614 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13615 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13616 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13617 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13618
13619Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13620192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13621
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013622IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13623Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13624trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13625IPv6 patterns.
13626
13627HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13628following situations :
13629 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13630 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13631 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13632 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13633 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13634 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13635 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13636 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13637 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13638 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013640
136417.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13642----------------------------------
13643
13644Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13645combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13646
13647 - AND (implicit)
13648 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13649 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013653 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13656indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13659"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13660requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13661is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13662
13663 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013664 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13665 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13666 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013667
13668To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13669and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13670
13671 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13672 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13673 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13674 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13675
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013676 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13678 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13679 use_backend www if host_www
13680
13681It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13682expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13683be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13684the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13685
13686 The following rule :
13687
13688 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013689 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013690
13691 Can also be written that way :
13692
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013693 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694
13695It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13696to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13697simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13698sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13699good use is the following :
13700
13701 With named ACLs :
13702
13703 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13704 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13705 monitor fail if site_dead
13706
13707 With anonymous ACLs :
13708
13709 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13710
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013711See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13712keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713
13714
137157.3. Fetching samples
13716---------------------
13717
13718Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13719against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13720sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13721ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13722of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13723available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13724
13725This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13726Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13727compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13728deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13729
13730The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13731matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13732method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13733indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13734
13735As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13736when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13737mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13738the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13739ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13740
13741Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13742multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13743when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013744incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13745are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13747all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13748
13749Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13750 - name
13751 - name(arg1)
13752 - name(arg1,arg2)
13753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013754
137557.3.1. Converters
13756-----------------
13757
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013758Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13759of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13760is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13761was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013763unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13764
13765These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13766sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13767the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013768support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013769
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013770A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13771support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13772supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13773(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13774bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013777
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001377851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13779 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13780 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13781 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13782 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13783 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13784
13785 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013786 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13787 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013788 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13789 frontend http-in
13790 bind *:8081
13791 default_backend servers
13792 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13793 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13794
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013795add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013796 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013797 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013798 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13799 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013806 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013807
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013808aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13809 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13810 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13811 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13812 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13813 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13814 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13815
13816 Example:
13817 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13818 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13819
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013820and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013821 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013822 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013823 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13824 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013825 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013826 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13827 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13828 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13829 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013831 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013832
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013833b64dec
13834 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13835 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13836
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013837base64
13838 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013839 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013840 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13841
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013842bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013843 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013844 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013846 presence of a flag).
13847
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013848bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13849 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13850 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013851 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013852
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013853concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13854 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13855 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13856 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13857 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13858 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13859 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13860 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13861 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13862 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13863 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013864 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13865 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13866 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13867 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013868
13869 Example:
13870 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13871 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13872 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013873 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013874 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13875
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013876cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013877 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13878 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013879
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013880crc32([<avalanche>])
13881 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13882 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13883 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13884 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13885 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13886 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13887 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13888 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13889 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13890 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013891 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13892
13893crc32c([<avalanche>])
13894 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13895 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13896 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13897 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13898 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13899 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13900 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13901 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013902
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013903da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013904 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13905 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13906 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13907 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013908 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013909 configuration language.
13910
13911 Example:
13912 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013913 bind *:8881
13914 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013915 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013916
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013917debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13918 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13919 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13920 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13921 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13922 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13923 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13924 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13925 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13926 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13927 printable sample types.
13928
13929 Example:
13930 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013932div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013933 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13934 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013935 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013936 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13937 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013938 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013939 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13940 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13941 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13942 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013944 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013945
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013946djb2([<avalanche>])
13947 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13948 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13949 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13950 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13951 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13952 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13953 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013954 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13955 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013956
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013957even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013958 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013959 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13960
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013961field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13962 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13963 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13964 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13965 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13966 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13967 fields.
13968
13969 Example :
13970 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13971 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13972 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13973 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13974 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013975
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013976hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013978 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013980 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013981
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013982hex2i
13983 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013984 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013985
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013986http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013987 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13988 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013989 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13990 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13991 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13992 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13993 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13994 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13995 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13996 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013997
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013998in_table(<table>)
13999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14001 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014003 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14004
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014005ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14006 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014007 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014008 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14009 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14010 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14011 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14012 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014013
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014014json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014015 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014016 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014017 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014018 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14019 of errors:
14020 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14021 bytes, ...)
14022 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14023 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14024
14025 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14026 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14027 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14028 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14029 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14030 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014031 - "ascii" : never fails;
14032 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14033 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014034 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014035 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014036 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14037 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14038
14039 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014040 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014041
14042 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014043 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014044 capture request header user-agent len 150
14045 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014046
14047 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14048 GET / HTTP/1.0
14049 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14050
14051 Output log:
14052 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014054language(<value>[,<default>])
14055 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14056 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14057 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14058 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14059 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14060 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14061 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14062 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14063 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014065 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14066 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014068 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014069
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014070 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14071 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014073 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14074 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14075 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14076 use_backend spanish if es
14077 use_backend french if fr
14078 use_backend english if en
14079 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014080
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014081length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014082 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14083 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14084 type. The result is of type integer.
14085
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014086lower
14087 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14088 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14089 type. The result is of type string.
14090
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014091ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14092 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14093 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14094 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14095 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14096 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14097 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14098
14099 Example :
14100
14101 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014103 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14104
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014105map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14106map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14107map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14108 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14109 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14110 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14111 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14112 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14113 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14114 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14115 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014117 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14118 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14119 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014120
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014121 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014122 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014123
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014124 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14125 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14126 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14127 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014128 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14129 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014130 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14131 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14132 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14133 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14134 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14135 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14136 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14137 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014138 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14139 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14140 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014141 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14142 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14143 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14144 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14145 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014146
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014147 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14148 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14149 the corresponding match text.
14150
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014151 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14152 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14153 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14154 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14155 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014156
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014157 Example :
14158
14159 # this is a comment and is ignored
14160 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14161 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14162 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14163 | | | `---------- value
14164 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14165 | `---------------------------- key
14166 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14167
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014168mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014169 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14170 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014171 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014172 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014173 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014174 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14175 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14176 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14177 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014178 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014179 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014180
14181mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014182 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014183 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14184 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014185 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014186 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014187 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014188 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14189 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014194
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014195nbsrv
14196 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14197 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14198 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14199 map lookup.
14200
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014201neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014202 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14203 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14204 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14205 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014206
14207not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014208 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014209 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014210 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014211 absence of a flag).
14212
14213odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014214 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014215 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14216
14217or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014218 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014219 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014220 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14221 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014222 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014223 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14224 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14225 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014228 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014229
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014230protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14231 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14232 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14233 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14234 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14235 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14236 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14237 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14238 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14239 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14240 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14241 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14242
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014243regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014244 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14245 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14246 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14247 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14248 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14249 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14250 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14251 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14252 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014253 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14254 of characters with other ones.
14255
14256 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14257 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14258 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14259 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14260 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14261 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014262
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014263 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014264
14265 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14266 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14267 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014268 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014269
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014270 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14271 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14272
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014273 # capture groups and backreferences
14274 # both lines do the same.
14275 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14276 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14277
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014278capture-req(<id>)
14279 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14280 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14281
14282 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014283 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14284 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014285
14286capture-res(<id>)
14287 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14288 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14289
14290 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014291 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14292 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014293
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014294sdbm([<avalanche>])
14295 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14296 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14297 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14298 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14299 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14300 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14301 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014302 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14303 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014304
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014305set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014306 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14307 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14308 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014309 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014310 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14311 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014312 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014313 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014316 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014317
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014318sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014319 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014320 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14321
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014322sha2([<bits>])
14323 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14324 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14325
14326 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14327 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14328
14329 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14330 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14331
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014332srv_queue
14333 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14334 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14335 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14336 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14337 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14338
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014339strcmp(<var>)
14340 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14341 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14342 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14343 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14344 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14345 shorter).
14346
14347 Example :
14348
14349 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14350 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14351 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14352
14353
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014354sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014355 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14356 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014357 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014358 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14359 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014360 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14362 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014363 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014364 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14365 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014366 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014367 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014368
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014369table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14373 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14374 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14375 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14376
14377
14378table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14381 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14382 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14383 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14384 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14385
14386table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014390 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14391 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14392
14393table_conn_cur(<table>)
14394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14396 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14397 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14398 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14399
14400table_conn_rate(<table>)
14401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14404 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14405 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14406
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014407table_gpt0(<table>)
14408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14411 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14412 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14413
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014414table_gpc0(<table>)
14415 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14416 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14417 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14418 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14419 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14420
14421table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14424 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14425 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14426 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14427 sample fetch keyword.
14428
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014429table_gpc1(<table>)
14430 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14431 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14432 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14433 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14434 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14435
14436table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14437 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14438 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14439 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14440 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14441 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14442 sample fetch keyword.
14443
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014444table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14445 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14446 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014447 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014448 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14449 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14450
14451table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14452 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14453 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14454 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14455 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14456 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14457 keyword.
14458
14459table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014462 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014463 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14464 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14465
14466table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14467 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14468 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14469 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14470 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14471 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14472 keyword.
14473
14474table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14475 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14476 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014478 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14479 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14480 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14481 keyword.
14482
14483table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014487 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14488 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14489 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14490 keyword.
14491
14492table_server_id(<table>)
14493 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14494 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14495 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14496 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14497 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14498 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14499
14500table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14501 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14502 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014503 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014504 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14505 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14506 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14507 keyword.
14508
14509table_sess_rate(<table>)
14510 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14511 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14512 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14513 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14514 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14515 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14516 keyword.
14517
14518table_trackers(<table>)
14519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14522 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14523 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14524 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14525 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14526 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14527 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14528 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14529
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014530upper
14531 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14532 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14533 type. The result is of type string.
14534
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014535url_dec
14536 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14537 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14538
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014539ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014540 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014541 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14542 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14543 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014544 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14545 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14546 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14547 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014548 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014549 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14550 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014551
14552 Example:
14553 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14554 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14555
14556 message Point {
14557 int32 latitude = 1;
14558 int32 longitude = 2;
14559 }
14560
14561 message PPoint {
14562 Point point = 59;
14563 }
14564
14565 message Rectangle {
14566 // One corner of the rectangle.
14567 PPoint lo = 48;
14568 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14569 PPoint hi = 49;
14570 }
14571
14572 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14573 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14574 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14575
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014576 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14577 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014578 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014579 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14580
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014581 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014582
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014583 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014584
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014585 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014586 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14587 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14588
14589 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14590 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14591 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14592
14593 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14594 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14595 interpret the previous binary sample.
14596
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014597
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014598unset-var(<var name>)
14599 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14600 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14601 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14602 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14603 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14604 response),
14605 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14606 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14607 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14608 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14609
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014610utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14611 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14612 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14613 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14614 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14615 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14616 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14617
14618 Example :
14619
14620 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014621 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014622 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14623
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014624word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14625 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14626 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14627 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014628 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014629 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14630 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14631
14632 Example :
14633 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14634 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14635 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14636 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14637 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014638 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014639
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014640wt6([<avalanche>])
14641 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14642 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14643 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14644 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14645 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14646 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14647 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014648 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14649 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014650
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014651xor(<value>)
14652 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014653 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014654 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014655 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014656 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014657 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14658 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014659 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014660 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14661 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014662 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014663 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014664
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014665xxh32([<seed>])
14666 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14667 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14668 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14669 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14670 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14671 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14672 as cryptographically secure.
14673
14674xxh64([<seed>])
14675 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14676 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14677 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14678 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14679 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14680 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14681 as cryptographically secure.
14682
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014683
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685--------------------------------------------
14686
14687A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14688not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14689"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14690The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14691
14692always_false : boolean
14693 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14694 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14695
14696always_true : boolean
14697 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14698 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14699
14700avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014701 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014702 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14703 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14704 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14705 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14706 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14707 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14708 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14709 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14710 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14711 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14712 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14713 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14714 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014717 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14718 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14719 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14720 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014721 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14722
14723be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14725 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14726 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14727 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14728 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014729 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14730 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014731
14732 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14733 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14734 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14737 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14738 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14739 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014740 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14742 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014743
14744 Example :
14745 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14746 backend dynamic
14747 mode http
14748 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14749 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014751bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014752 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14753 of the string.
14754
14755bool(<bool>) : bool
14756 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14757 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014761 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14763 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014764
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014765 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014766 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014767 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14768
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014769 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14770 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014771
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014772 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014773 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014775 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014778 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014779
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014780 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14781 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014783 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014784
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014785cpu_calls : integer
14786 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14787 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14788 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14789 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14790 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14791 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14792
14793cpu_ns_avg : integer
14794 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14795 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14796 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14797 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14798 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14799 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14800 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14801 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14802 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14803 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14804 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14805
14806cpu_ns_tot : integer
14807 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14808 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14809 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14810 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14811 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14812 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14813 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14814 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14815 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14816 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14817 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14818 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14819 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14820
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014821date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014822 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014823
14824 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14825 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14826 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014827 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14828
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014829 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14830 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14831 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14832 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14833 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14834
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014835 Example :
14836
14837 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14838 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014839
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014840 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14841 # millisecond granularity
14842 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14843
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014844date_us : integer
14845 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14846 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14847 from the same timeval structure.
14848
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014849distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14850 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14851 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14852 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14853 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14854 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14855 list of supported tokens.
14856
14857distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14858 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14859 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14860 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14861 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14862 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14863 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14864 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14865 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14866 supported tokens.
14867
14868 Example :
14869 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14870 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14871 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14872 # send large files to the big farm
14873 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14874
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014875env(<name>) : string
14876 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14877 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14878 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14879 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14880 certain way.
14881
14882 Examples :
14883 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14884 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14885
14886 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14887 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14890 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014891 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14892 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14894 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14897 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014898
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014899fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14900 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14901 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14902 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14905 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14906 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14907 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14908 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14909 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14910 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14911 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14912 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014913
14914 Example :
14915 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14916 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14917 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14918 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14919 frontend mail
14920 bind :25
14921 mode tcp
14922 maxconn 100
14923 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14924 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14925 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14926 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014927
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014928hostname : string
14929 Returns the system hostname.
14930
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014931int(<integer>) : signed integer
14932 Returns a signed integer.
14933
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014934ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14935 Returns an ipv4.
14936
14937ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14938 Returns an ipv6.
14939
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014940lat_ns_avg : integer
14941 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14942 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14943 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14944 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14945 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14946 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14947 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14948 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14949 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14950 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14951 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14952 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14953 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14954 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14955
14956lat_ns_tot : integer
14957 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14958 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14959 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14960 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14961 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14962 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14963 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14964 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14965 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14966 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14967 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14968 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14969 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14970 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14971 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14972 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14973 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14974 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14975 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14976
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014977meth(<method>) : method
14978 Returns a method.
14979
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014980nbproc : integer
14981 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14982 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14983 and debugging purposes.
14984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14986 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14987 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14988 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014989 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14990 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14991 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014992
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014993prio_class : integer
14994 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14995 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14996 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14997
14998prio_offset : integer
14999 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15000 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15001 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15002 set-priority-offset".
15003
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015004proc : integer
15005 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15006 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15007 debugging purposes.
15008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015010 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15011 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15012 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15014 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15015 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15016 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15017 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15018
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015019rand([<range>]) : integer
15020 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15021 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15022 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15023 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15024 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15025
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015026uuid([<version>]) : string
15027 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15028 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15029 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15033 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15034 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15035 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15036 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015037 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15038 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15039
15040srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15042 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15043 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15044 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15045 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15046 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15047 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15048
15049 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15050 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051
15052srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15053 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15054 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15055 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015056 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15058 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15059 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15060
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015061srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15063 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15064 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15065 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15066 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15067 fetch methods.
15068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15070 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15071 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015072 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15074 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015075 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 overloading servers).
15077
15078 Example :
15079 # Redirect to a separate back
15080 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15081 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15082 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15083
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015084stopping : boolean
15085 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15086 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15087 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15088
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015089str(<string>) : string
15090 Returns a string.
15091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15093 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15094 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15095
15096table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15097 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15098 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15099 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15100
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015101thread : integer
15102 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15103 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15104 and debugging purposes.
15105
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015106var(<var-name>) : undefined
15107 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015108 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15109 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015110 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015111 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15112 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015113 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015114 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15115 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015116 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015117 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015118
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151197.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120----------------------------------
15121
15122The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15123closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15124methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15125sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15126TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015127the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15128counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015129"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15130used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15131can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15132Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15133table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15134tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15135currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015137bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015138 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15139 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15140 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142be_id : integer
15143 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15144 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15145
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015146be_name : string
15147 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15148 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150dst : ip
15151 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15152 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15153 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15154 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015155 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15156 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15157 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15158 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15159 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15160 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015161
15162dst_conn : integer
15163 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15164 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15165 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15166 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15167 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15168 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15169 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15170 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015171
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015172dst_is_local : boolean
15173 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15174 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15175 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15176 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015177 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015178 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15179 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15180 it only once per connection.
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182dst_port : integer
15183 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15184 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15185 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15186 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15187 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15188 an HTTP header.
15189
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015190fc_http_major : integer
15191 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15192 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15193 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15194
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015195fc_pp_authority : string
15196 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15197 if any.
15198
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015199fc_pp_unique_id : string
15200 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15201 if any.
15202
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015203fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15204 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15205 header.
15206
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015207fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15208 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15209 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15210 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15211 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15212 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15213 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15214
15215fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15216 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15217 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15218 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15219 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15220 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15221 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15222
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015223fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015224 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15225 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15226 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15227 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15228
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015229fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015230 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15231 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15232 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15233 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15234
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015235fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015236 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15237 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15238 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15239 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15240
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015241fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015242 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15243 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15244 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15245 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15246
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015247fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015248 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15249 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15250 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15251 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15252
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015253fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015254 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15258
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015259fe_defbe : string
15260 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15261 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015263fe_id : integer
15264 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015265 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15267
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015268fe_name : string
15269 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15270 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15271 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15272
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015273sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015274sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15275sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15276sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015277 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15278 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15279 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15280
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015281sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015282sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15283sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015285 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15286 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15287 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015289sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015290sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15291sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15292sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015293 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15294 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015295 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15296 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15297 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015298
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015299 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015300 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15301 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015302 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15303 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15304 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015305 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15306 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15307
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015308sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15309sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15310sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15311sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15312 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15313 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15314 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15315 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15316 when a first ACL was verified.
15317
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015318sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015319sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15320sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15321sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015322 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015323 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015325sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015326sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15327sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15328sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015329 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15330 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15331 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015333sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015334sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15335sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15336sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015337 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15338 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15339 See also src_conn_rate.
15340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015341sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015342sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15343sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15344sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015345 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015346 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015347
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015348sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15349sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15350sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15351sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15352 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15353 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15354
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015355sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15356sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15357sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15358sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15359 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15360 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015362sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015363sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15364sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15365sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015366 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15367 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15368 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015369 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15370 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15371 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015372
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015373sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15374sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15375sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15376sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15377 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15378 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15379 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15380 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15381 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15382 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015384sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015385sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15386sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15387sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015388 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015389 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15390 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015392sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015393sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015396 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15397 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15398 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15399 src_http_err_rate.
15400
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015401sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015402sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15403sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15404sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015406 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15407 src_http_req_cnt.
15408
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015409sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015410sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15411sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15412sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015413 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15414 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15415 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15416 src_http_req_rate.
15417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015418sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015419sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15420sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15421sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015422 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015423 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15424 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15425 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15426 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015427
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015428 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015429 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15430 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015431 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15432
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015433sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15434sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15435sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15436sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15437 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15438 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15439 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15440 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15441 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015443sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015444sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15445sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15446sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015447 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15448 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15449 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015451sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015452sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15453sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15454sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015455 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15456 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15457 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015459sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015460sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15461sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15462sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015463 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015464 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15465 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15466 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015467 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015470sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015471sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15472sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15473sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015474 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15475 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15476 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15477 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15478 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015479 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015480
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015481sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015482sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15483sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15484sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015485 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15486 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15487 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015489sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015490sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15491sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15492sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015493 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15494 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015495 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015496 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15497 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15499 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15500 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502so_id : integer
15503 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15504 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15505 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015506
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015507so_name : string
15508 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15509 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15510 strings instead of integers.
15511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015513 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15515 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15516 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015517 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15518 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15519 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015520 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15521 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15522 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15523 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15524 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15525 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15526 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015527
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015528 Example:
15529 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15530 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15533 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15534 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15535 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015536 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15539 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15540 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015541 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015542 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15545 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15546 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15547 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15548 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15549 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15550 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015551
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015552 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015553 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15554 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15555 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15556 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015557 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015558 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15559 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15560
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015561src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15562 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15563 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15564 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15565 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15566 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15567 was verified.
15568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015570 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015572 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015573 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015576 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15578 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015579 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15582 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15583 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15584 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015585 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015588 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015590 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015591 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015592
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015593src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15594 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15595 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15596 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15597 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15598
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015599src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15600 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15601 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15602 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15603 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015606 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015608 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15609 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015610 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15611 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15612 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015613
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015614src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15615 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15616 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15617 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15618 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15619 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15620 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15621 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015624 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015626 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015627 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15631 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15632 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15633 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15634 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015635 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015638 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15640 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015641 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15644 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15645 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15646 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015647 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015648 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15651 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15652 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15653 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015654 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15656 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015657
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015658 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015659 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015660 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015661 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015662
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015663src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15664 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15665 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15666 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15667 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15668 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15669 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15670
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015671src_is_local : boolean
15672 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15673 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15674 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15675 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015676 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015677 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15678 once per connection.
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015681 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15682 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15683 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15684 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15685 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015688 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15689 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15690 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15691 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15692 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694src_port : integer
15695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15696 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15697 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15698 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015701 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015702 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15703 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15704 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015705 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15708 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15709 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15710 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15711 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015712 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15715 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15716 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15717 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15718 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15719 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15720 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15721 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15722 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015723
15724 Example :
15725 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15726 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15727 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15728 listen ssh
15729 bind :22
15730 mode tcp
15731 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015732 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015734 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736srv_id : integer
15737 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15738 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15739 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015740
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015741srv_name : string
15742 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15743 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15744 debugging.
15745
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157467.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15750closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15751when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15752usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015753future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015754
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001575551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15756 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15757 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15758 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15759 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15760 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15761
15762 Example :
15763 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15764 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15765 # the request.
15766 frontend http-in
15767 bind *:8081
15768 default_backend servers
15769 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15770 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15771
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015772ssl_bc : boolean
15773 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15774 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15775 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15776
15777ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15778 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15779 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15780
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015781ssl_bc_alpn : string
15782 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15783 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015784 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015785 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15786 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15787 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15788 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15789 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15790 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15791
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015792ssl_bc_cipher : string
15793 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15794 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15795
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015796ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15797 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15798 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15799 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15800
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015801ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15802 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15803 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15804 session or a TLS ticket.
15805
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015806ssl_bc_npn : string
15807 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15808 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015809 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015810 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15811 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15812 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15813 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15814 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15815
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015816ssl_bc_protocol : string
15817 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15818 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15819
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015820ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015821 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015822 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15823 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015824
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015825ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15826 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15827 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15828 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15829
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015830ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15831 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15832 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15833 if session was reused or not.
15834
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015835ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15836 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15837 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15838 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15839 BoringSSL.
15840
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015841ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15842 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15843 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15846 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15847 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15848 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15849 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15850 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15853 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15854 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15855 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15856 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015857
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015858ssl_c_der : binary
15859 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15860 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15861 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863ssl_c_err : integer
15864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15865 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15866 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15867 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15868 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015869
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015870ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15872 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15873 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15874 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15875 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15876 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15877 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15878 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015879 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15880 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15881 LDAP v3.
15882 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15883 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885ssl_c_key_alg : string
15886 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15887 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15888 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890ssl_c_notafter : string
15891 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15892 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15893 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895ssl_c_notbefore : string
15896 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15897 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15898 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015899
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015900ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15902 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15903 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15904 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15905 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15906 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15907 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15908 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015909 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15910 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15911 LDAP v3.
15912 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15913 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915ssl_c_serial : binary
15916 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15917 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15918 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15921 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15922 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15923 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015924 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15925 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15926
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015927 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015928 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15931 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15932 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15933 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_c_used : boolean
15936 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15937 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939ssl_c_verify : integer
15940 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15941 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15942 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15943 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945ssl_c_version : integer
15946 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15947 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015948
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015949ssl_f_der : binary
15950 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15951 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15952 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15953
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015954ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15956 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15957 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15958 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015959 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15961 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15962 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015963 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15964 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15965 LDAP v3.
15966 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15967 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969ssl_f_key_alg : string
15970 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15971 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15972 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974ssl_f_notafter : string
15975 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15976 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15977 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979ssl_f_notbefore : string
15980 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15981 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15982 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015983
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015984ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15986 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15987 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15988 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15989 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15990 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15991 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15992 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015993 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15994 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15995 LDAP v3.
15996 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15997 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999ssl_f_serial : binary
16000 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16001 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16002 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016003
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016004ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16005 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16006 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16007 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16010 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16011 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16012 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014ssl_f_version : integer
16015 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16016 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16017
16018ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016019 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16020 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16021 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 Example :
16024 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16025 listen http-https
16026 bind :80
16027 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16028 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16029
16030ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16031 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16032 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16033
16034ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016035 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16037 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16038 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16039 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16040 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16041 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16042 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16043 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045ssl_fc_cipher : string
16046 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16047 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016048
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016049ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16050 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16051 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016052 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016053
16054ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16055 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16056 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016057 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016058
16059ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16060 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16061 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16062 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016063 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016064 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016065
16066ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16067 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16068 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016069 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016070
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016071ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16072 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16073 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16074 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016077 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16078 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016079 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16080 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16081 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16082 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016083
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016084ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16085 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16086 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16087 wait until the handshake happened.
16088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16090 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016091 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16092 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016093 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016094 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016095
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016096ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016097 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016098 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16099 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016102 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16104 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16105 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16106 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16107 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16108 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16109 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111ssl_fc_protocol : string
16112 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16113 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016114
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016115ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016116 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016117 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16118 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016119
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016120ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16121 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16122 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16123 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16126 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16127 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16128 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16129 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016130
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016131ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16132 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16133 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16134 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16135 BoringSSL.
16136
16137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138ssl_fc_sni : string
16139 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16140 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16141 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16142 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16143 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16144
16145 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16146 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16147 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016148 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016149 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16153 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16156 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16157 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016158
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016159
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161607.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16164sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16165only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16166For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16167be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16168can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16169sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16170for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16171content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016174 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16176 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16179 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016180 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016182
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016183req.hdrs : string
16184 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16185 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16186 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16187 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16188
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016189req.hdrs_bin : binary
16190 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16191 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16192 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16193 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16194 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16195 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16196
16197 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16198
16199 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16200 str: <int:length><bytes>
16201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202req.len : integer
16203req_len : integer (deprecated)
16204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16205 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16206 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16207 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16208 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16209 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16210 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16211 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16214 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016215 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16216 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16217 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16218 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220 ACL alternatives :
16221 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16224 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16225 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16226 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16227 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229 ACL alternatives :
16230 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234req.proto_http : boolean
16235req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16236 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16237 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16238 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16239 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16240 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16241 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16242 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 Example:
16245 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16246 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16247 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016248 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16251rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16252 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16253 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16254 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16255 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16256 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16257 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16258 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16261 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16262 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16263 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16264 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16265 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 ACL derivatives :
16268 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 Example :
16271 listen tse-farm
16272 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16273 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16274 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16275 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16276 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16277 persist rdp-cookie
16278 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16279 # This is only useful makes sense if
16280 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16281 stick-table type string size 204800
16282 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16283 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16284 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16287 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16290rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16291 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16292 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16293 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16294 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 ACL derivatives :
16297 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016298
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016299req.ssl_alpn : string
16300 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16301 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16302 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16303 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16304 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16305 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016306 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016307
16308 Examples :
16309 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16310 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16311 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016312 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016313 default_backend bk_default
16314
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016315req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16316 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16317 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016318 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16319 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16320 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16321 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16322 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16325req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16326 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16327 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16328 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16329 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16330 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16331 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16332 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334req.ssl_sni : string
16335req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16336 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16337 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16338 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16339 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16340 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16341 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16342 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16343 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16344 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16345 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16346 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16347 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349 ACL derivatives :
16350 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 Examples :
16353 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16354 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16355 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16356 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16357 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016358
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016359req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16360 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16361 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16362 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16363 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16364 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16365 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16366 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16367 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16368 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370req.ssl_ver : integer
16371req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16372 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16373 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16374 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16375 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16376 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16377 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16378 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016379 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382 ACL derivatives :
16383 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016384
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016385res.len : integer
16386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16387 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16388 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16389 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16390 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16391 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16392 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16393 content inspection.
16394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16396 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016397 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16398 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16399 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16400 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16403 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16404 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16405 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16406 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016409
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016410res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16411rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16412 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16413 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16414 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16415 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16416 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16417 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16418 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420wait_end : boolean
16421 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16422 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016423 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16425 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016426 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16428 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430 Examples :
16431 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16432 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16433 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16436 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16437 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16438 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16439 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16440 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16441 tcp-request content reject
16442
16443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445--------------------------------------
16446
16447It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16448This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16449data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16450its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16451HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16452content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16453to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16454more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16455response are indexed.
16456
16457base : string
16458 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16459 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16460 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16461 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16462 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16463 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16464 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16465 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16466
16467 ACL derivatives :
16468 base : exact string match
16469 base_beg : prefix match
16470 base_dir : subdir match
16471 base_dom : domain match
16472 base_end : suffix match
16473 base_len : length match
16474 base_reg : regex match
16475 base_sub : substring match
16476
16477base32 : integer
16478 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16479 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16480 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016481 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16482 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16483 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484
16485base32+src : binary
16486 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16487 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16488 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16489 per-URL counters.
16490
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016491capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16492 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16493 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16494 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16495
16496capture.req.method : string
16497 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16498 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16499 because it's allocated.
16500
16501capture.req.uri : string
16502 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16503 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16504 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16505 allocated.
16506
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016507capture.req.ver : string
16508 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16509 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16510 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16511
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016512capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16513 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16514 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16515 The first entry is an index of 0.
16516 See also: "capture response header"
16517
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016518capture.res.ver : string
16519 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16520 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16521 persistent flag.
16522
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016523req.body : binary
16524 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16525 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16526 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16527 the first chunk is analyzed.
16528
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016529req.body_param([<name>) : string
16530 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16531 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16532 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16533 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16534 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16535 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16536 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16537 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16538 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16539 given.
16540
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016541req.body_len : integer
16542 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16543 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16544 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16545 "option http-buffer-request".
16546
16547req.body_size : integer
16548 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16549 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16550 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16551 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16552 "option http-buffer-request".
16553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554req.cook([<name>]) : string
16555cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16556 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16557 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16558 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16559 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16560 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16561 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16562 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16563 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16564
16565 ACL derivatives :
16566 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16567 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16568 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16569 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16570 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16571 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16572 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16573 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16576cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16577 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16578 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16581cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16582 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16583 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16584 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16585 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16588 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16589 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16590 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16591 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016592 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16594 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16595 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16596 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16599 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16600 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16601 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16602 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016603 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16606 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16607 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16608 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16609 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16610 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16611 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16612 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16613 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16616 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16617 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16618 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16619 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16623 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16624 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16625 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16626 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16627 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16628 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16629 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016630 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016631 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016632 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634 ACL derivatives :
16635 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16636 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16637 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16638 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16639 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16640 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16641 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16642 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16643
16644req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16645hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16646 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16647 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16648 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16649 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16650 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16651 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16652 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16653 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16654 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16655
16656req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16657hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16658 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16659 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16660 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16661 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16662 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016663 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016664 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16665 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16666
16667req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16668hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16669 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16670 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16671 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16672 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16673 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16674 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16675 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16676
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016677
16678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016679http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16680 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16681 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16682 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16683 basic auth is supported.
16684
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016685http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16686 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16687 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16688 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16689 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016690 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16691 basic auth is supported.
16692
16693 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016694 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16695 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16696 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16697 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016699http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016700 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16701 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16702 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016703
16704http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016705 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16706 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16707 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016708
16709http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016710 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16711 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16712 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016715 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16716 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016717 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16718 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720method : integer + string
16721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16722 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16723 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16724 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16725 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16726 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16727 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016729 ACL derivatives :
16730 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016732 Example :
16733 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16734 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16735 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737path : string
16738 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16739 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16740 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16741 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16742 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016743 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016744 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746 ACL derivatives :
16747 path : exact string match
16748 path_beg : prefix match
16749 path_dir : subdir match
16750 path_dom : domain match
16751 path_end : suffix match
16752 path_len : length match
16753 path_reg : regex match
16754 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016755
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016756query : string
16757 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16758 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16759 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16760 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016761 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016762 which stops before the question mark.
16763
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016764req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16765 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16766 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16767 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16768 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770req.ver : string
16771req_ver : string (deprecated)
16772 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16773 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16774 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 ACL derivatives :
16777 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016779res.comp : boolean
16780 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16781 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16782 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784res.comp_algo : string
16785 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16786 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16787 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789res.cook([<name>]) : string
16790scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16791 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16792 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16793 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795 ACL derivatives :
16796 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16799scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16800 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16801 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16802 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16805scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16806 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16807 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16808 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16811 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16812 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16813 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16814 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16815 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16816 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16817 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16818 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16819 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16822 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16823 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16824 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16825 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16826 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16829shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16830 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16831 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16832 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16833 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16834 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16835 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16836 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16837 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839 ACL derivatives :
16840 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16841 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16842 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16843 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16844 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16845 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16846 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16847 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16848
16849res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16850shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16851 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16852 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16853 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16854 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16855 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16858shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16859 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16860 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16861 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16862 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16863 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16864 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016865
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016866res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16867 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16868 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16869 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16870 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016872res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16873shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16874 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16875 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16876 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16877 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16878 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16879 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881res.ver : string
16882resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16883 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16884 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016886 ACL derivatives :
16887 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16890 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16891 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016892 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16896 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898status : integer
16899 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16900 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16901 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016902
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016903unique-id : string
16904 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16905 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16906 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16907 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16908 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16909 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911url : string
16912 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16913 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16914 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16915 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16916 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16917 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16918 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920 ACL derivatives :
16921 url : exact string match
16922 url_beg : prefix match
16923 url_dir : subdir match
16924 url_dom : domain match
16925 url_end : suffix match
16926 url_len : length match
16927 url_reg : regex match
16928 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930url_ip : ip
16931 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16932 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16933 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16934 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16935 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16936 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16937 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939url_port : integer
16940 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16941 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16942 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16943 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016944
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016945urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16946url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016947 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16948 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016949 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16950 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16951 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16952 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16954 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016955 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16956 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 ACL derivatives :
16959 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16960 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16961 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16962 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16963 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16964 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16965 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16966 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016967
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016969 Example :
16970 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16971 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16972 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16973 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016974
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016975urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16977 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16978 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016979
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016980url32 : integer
16981 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16982 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16983 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16984 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16985 is an unsigned integer.
16986
16987url32+src : binary
16988 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16989 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16990 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16991
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016992
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100169937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16994---------------------------------------
16995
16996This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16997used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16998purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16999There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17000or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17001any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17002for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17003
17004internal.htx.data : integer
17005 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17006 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17007
17008internal.htx.free : integer
17009 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17010 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17011
17012internal.htx.free_data : integer
17013 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17014 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17015
17016internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17017 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17018 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17019 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17020
17021internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17022 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17023 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17024
17025internal.htx.size : integer
17026 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17027 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17028
17029internal.htx.used : integer
17030 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17031 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17032 direction.
17033
17034internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17035 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17036 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17037 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17038 of the special value :
17039 * head : The oldest inserted block
17040 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017041 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017042
17043internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17044 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17045 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17046 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17047 integer or one of the special value :
17048 * head : The oldest inserted block
17049 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017050 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017051
17052internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17053 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17054 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17055 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17056 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17057
17058 * head : The oldest inserted block
17059 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017060 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017061
17062internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17063 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17064 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17065 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17066 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17067
17068 * head : The oldest inserted block
17069 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017070 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017071
17072internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17073 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17074 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17075 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17076 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17077
17078 * head : The oldest inserted block
17079 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017080 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017081
17082internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17083 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17084 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17085 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17086 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17087
17088 * head : The oldest inserted block
17089 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017090 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017091
17092internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17093 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17094 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17095 it returns false.
17096
17097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017099---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017101Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17102every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017103order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017105ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17106---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017107FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017108HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017109HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17110HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017111HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17112HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17113HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17114HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17115LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017116METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017117METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017118METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17119METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17120METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17121METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017122METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017123METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017124RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017125REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017126TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017127WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17128---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017129
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171318. Logging
17132----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017133
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017134One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17135provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17136very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17137provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17138state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017139to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017140headers.
17141
17142In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17143about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17144send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17145
17146 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17147 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17148 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17149 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17150 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017151 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017152 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153
17154The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17155allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17156as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17157while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17158real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17159delay.
17160
17161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171628.1. Log levels
17163---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017165TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017167HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17168in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17169track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17170syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17171about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017172
17173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171748.2. Log formats
17175----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017176
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017177HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017178and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17179slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17180options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017181
17182 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17183 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17184 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17185 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17186 extents.
17187
17188 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17189 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17190 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17191 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17192 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17193
17194 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17195 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17196 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17197 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17198 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17199
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017200 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17201 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17202 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17203 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17204
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017205 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17208specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17209field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17210servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17211always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17212identifier.
17213
17214Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17215 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17216 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17217 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17218 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17219
17220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172218.2.1. Default log format
17222-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223
17224This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17225as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17226format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17227
17228 Example :
17229 listen www
17230 mode http
17231 log global
17232 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17233
17234 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17235 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17236 (www/HTTP)
17237
17238 Field Format Extract from the example above
17239 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17240 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17241 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17242 4 'to' to
17243 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17244 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17245
17246Detailed fields description :
17247 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17248 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17249 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17250 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17251 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17252 and processed the connection.
17253 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17254
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017255In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17256"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17257connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017259It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17260will eventually disappear.
17261
17262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172638.2.2. TCP log format
17264---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265
17266The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17267is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17268information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17269counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17270emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17271environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17272the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17273sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017274specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17275not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17276fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17277marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278
17279 Example :
17280 frontend fnt
17281 mode tcp
17282 option tcplog
17283 log global
17284 default_backend bck
17285
17286 backend bck
17287 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17288
17289 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17290 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17291 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17292
17293 Field Format Extract from the example above
17294 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17295 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17296 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17297 4 frontend_name fnt
17298 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17299 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17300 7 bytes_read* 212
17301 8 termination_state --
17302 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17303 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17304
17305Detailed fields description :
17306 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017307 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17308 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17309 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017310 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017311 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017312 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017313
17314 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017315 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17316 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17317 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318
17319 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17320 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17321 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017322 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17323 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17324 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17325 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017326
17327 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17328 and processed the connection.
17329
17330 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17331 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17332 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17333 applications.
17334
17335 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17336 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17337 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17338 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17339 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17340
17341 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17342 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17343 See "Timers" below for more details.
17344
17345 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17346 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17347 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17348 "Timers" below for more details.
17349
17350 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017351 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17353 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17354 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17355 details.
17356
17357 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17358 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17359 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17360 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17361 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17362
17363 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17364 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17365 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17366 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17367 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17368 for more details.
17369
17370 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017371 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17373 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17374 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017375 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376
17377 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17378 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17379 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17380 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17381 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17382 caused by a denial of service attack.
17383
17384 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17385 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17386 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17387 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17388 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17389 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17390 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17391 denial of service attack.
17392
17393 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17394 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17395 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17396 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17397 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17398 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17399 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17400 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17401 be processed than on other servers.
17402
17403 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17404 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17405 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17406 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17407 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17408 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17409 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17410 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17411 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17412 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17413 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17414 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17415 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17416
17417 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17418 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17419 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17420 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17421 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17422 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017423 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17425
17426 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17427 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17428 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17429 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17430 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17431 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017433 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17434 occurs.
17435
17436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174378.2.3. HTTP log format
17438----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017439
17440The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17441is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17442the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17443are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17444emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17445generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17446"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17447which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017448frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17449is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017450
17451Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17452slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17453with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17454
17455 Example :
17456 frontend http-in
17457 mode http
17458 option httplog
17459 log global
17460 default_backend bck
17461
17462 backend static
17463 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17464
17465 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17466 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17467 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017468 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469
17470 Field Format Extract from the example above
17471 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17472 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017473 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017474 4 frontend_name http-in
17475 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017476 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477 7 status_code 200
17478 8 bytes_read* 2750
17479 9 captured_request_cookie -
17480 10 captured_response_cookie -
17481 11 termination_state ----
17482 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17483 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17484 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17485 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17486 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017487
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017488Detailed fields description :
17489 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017490 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17491 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17492 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017493 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017494 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017495 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496
17497 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017498 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17499 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17500 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017502 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17503 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504
17505 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17506 and processed the connection.
17507
17508 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17509 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17510 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17511
17512 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17513 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17514 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17515 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17516 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17517 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17518
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017519 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17520 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17521 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017522 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017523 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17524 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017525 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17526 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527
17528 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17529 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017530 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17533 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017534 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17535 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536
17537 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17538 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17539 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17540 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17541 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017542 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17543 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017545 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17546 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17547 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17548 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17549 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17550 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17551 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017552 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017553
17554 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17555 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17556 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17557
17558 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17559 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017560 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17562 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17563 overflowing.
17564
17565 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17566 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17567 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17568 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17569 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17570 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17571 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17572 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17573
17574 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17575 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17576 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17577 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17578 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17579 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17580 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17581 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17582
17583 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17584 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17585 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17586 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17587 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17588 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17589 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17590
17591 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017592 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017593 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17594 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17595 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017596 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017597 system.
17598
17599 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17600 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17601 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17602 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17603 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17604 caused by a denial of service attack.
17605
17606 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17607 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17608 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17609 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17610 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17611 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17612 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17613 denial of service attack.
17614
17615 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17616 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17617 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17618 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17619 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17620 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17621 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17622 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17623 processed than on other servers.
17624
17625 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17626 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17627 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17628 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17629 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17630 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17631 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17632 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17633 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17634 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17635 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17636 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17637 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17638
17639 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17640 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17641 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17642 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17643 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17644 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017645 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17647
17648 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17649 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17650 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17651 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17652 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17653 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017654 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017655 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17656 occurs.
17657
17658 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17659 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17660 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17661 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17662 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17663 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17664 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17665 cookies" below for more details.
17666
17667 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17668 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17669 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17670 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17671 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17672 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17673 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17674 and cookies" below for more details.
17675
17676 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17677 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17678 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17679 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17680 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17681 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17682 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17683 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17684
17685
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200176868.2.4. Custom log format
17687------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017688
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017689The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017690mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017692HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017693Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17694separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17695prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17696
17697Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17698variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017699("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017700
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017701If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017702as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017703less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17704the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17705
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017706Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017707In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017708in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017709
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017710Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17711'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17712https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17713such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17714
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017715Flags are :
17716 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017717 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017718 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17719 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017720
17721 Example:
17722
17723 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17724 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17725
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017726 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17727
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017728At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017730 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17731 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017732
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017733the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017735 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17736 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17737 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017738
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017739and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17740
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017741 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17742 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017743
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017744Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17745
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017746 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017747 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017748 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17749 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17750 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017751 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17752 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17753 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017754 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017755 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17756 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017757 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017758 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17759 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017760 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017761 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017762 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017763 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017764 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017765 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017766 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017767 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17768 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17769 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17770 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17771 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017772 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017773 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17774 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017775 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017776 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17777 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017778 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17779 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17780 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017781 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017782 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17783 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017784 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017785 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17786 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17787 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017788 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017789 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017790 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17791 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17792 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17793 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017794 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017795 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017796 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017797 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017798 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017799 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017800 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17801 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17802 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017803 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017804 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17805 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017806 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017807 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17808 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017809 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017810 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017811 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017812 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017813
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017814 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017815
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017816
178178.2.5. Error log format
17818-----------------------
17819
17820When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17821protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17822By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17823"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017824will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017825logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17826
17827The format looks like this :
17828
17829 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17830 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17831 Connection error during SSL handshake
17832
17833 Field Format Extract from the example above
17834 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17835 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17836 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17837 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17838 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17839
17840These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17841failures.
17842
17843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178448.3. Advanced logging options
17845-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017846
17847Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17848just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17849options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17850for more information about their usage.
17851
17852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17854------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855
17856It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17857haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17858commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17859monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17860ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17861
17862 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17863 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17864 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17865 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17866
17867 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17868 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17869 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017870 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017871 such as other load-balancers.
17872
17873 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17874 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17875 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17876
17877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17879----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017880
17881The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17882what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17883or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17886log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17887after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17888is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17889with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17890with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17891
17892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17894------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017895
17896Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17897for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17898"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17899retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17900raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17901a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17902file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17903you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17904"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17905
17906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17908--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017909
17910Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17911multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17912them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17913"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17914logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17915error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17916and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17917too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17918useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17919alternative.
17920
17921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179228.4. Timing events
17923------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924
17925Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17926reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17927the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17928frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017929mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17930addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17931
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017932Timings events in HTTP mode:
17933
17934 first request 2nd request
17935 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17936 t tr t tr ...
17937 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17938 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17939 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17940 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17941 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17942
17943Timings events in TCP mode:
17944
17945 TCP session
17946 |<----------------->|
17947 t t
17948 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17949 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17950 |<------ Tt ------->|
17951
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017952 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017953 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017954 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17955 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17956 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017957 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017958 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17959 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17960 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17961 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017963 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17964 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17965 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017966 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17967 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17968 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17969 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17970 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17971 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017972
17973 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17974 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17975 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17976 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17977 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17978 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17979 request typed by hand during a test.
17980
17981 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17982 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017984 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17985 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17986 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17987 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017988
17989 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17990 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17991 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17992 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17993 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17994
17995 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17996 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17997 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17998 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17999 connection never established.
18000
18001 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18002 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18003 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18004 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18005 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18006 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18007 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18008 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18009 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18010 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18011 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018013 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18014 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18015 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18016 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18017 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18018 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18019
18020 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18021
18022 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18023 "Ta" can never be negative.
18024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18026 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018027 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18028 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018029 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018030
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018031 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032
18033 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018034 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18035 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018036
18037These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18038protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18039that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018040due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18041"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18042that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018043
18044Most common cases :
18045
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018046 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18047 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18048 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18049 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18050 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18051 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18052 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18053 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18054 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18055 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18056 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018057 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018058
18059 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18060 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18061 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18062 of ms on remote networks.
18063
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018064 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18065 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18066 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018067
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018068 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18069 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18070 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18071 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18072 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18073 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18074 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18075 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18076 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018077
18078Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018080 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018082 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018084 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18086 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18087
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018088 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018089 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18090 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18091 flags.
18092
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018093 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18094 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018095 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18096 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18097 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18098 the client connection was maintained open.
18099
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018100 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018101 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018102 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18104
18105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181068.5. Session state at disconnection
18107-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108
18109TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18110"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
181112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18112each of which has a special meaning :
18113
18114 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18115 session to terminate :
18116
18117 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18118
18119 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18120 server explicitly refused it.
18121
18122 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18123 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18124 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18125 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018127
18128 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18129 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018130
18131 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18132 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18133 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18134 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18135 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18136
18137 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18138 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18139 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18140 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18141 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18142
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018143 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18144 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18145
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018146 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18147 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18148 backup connections when going up.
18149
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018150 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018152 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18153 send or receive data.
18154
18155 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18156 send or receive data.
18157
18158 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18159 with nothing left in the buffers.
18160
18161 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018163 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018164 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18165
18166 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18167 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18168 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18169 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18170 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18171
18172 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18173 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18174
18175 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18176 server (HTTP only).
18177
18178 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18179
18180 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18181 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18182 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18183
18184 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18185 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18186 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18187
18188 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18189
18190 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18191 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18192
18193 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18194 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18195 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18196
18197 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18198 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018199 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18200 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018201
18202 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18203 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18204 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18205 another server.
18206
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018207 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018208 server.
18209
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018210 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18211 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18212 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18213 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18214
18215 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18216 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18217 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18218 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18219
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018220 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18221 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18222 "use-server" rule).
18223
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018224 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18225
18226 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18227 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18228
18229 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18230
18231 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18232 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18233 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18234
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018235 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18236 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018237 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018238 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18239 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18240
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018241 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18242
18243 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18244 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18245
18246 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18247
18248 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18249
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018250The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18251was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18253starvation, attacks, etc...
18254
18255The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18256alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18257easier finding and understanding.
18258
18259 Flags Reason
18260
18261 -- Normal termination.
18262
18263 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18264 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18265 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18266 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18267
18268 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18269 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18270 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18271 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18272 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18273 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018274
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018275 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18276 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018277 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018278
18279 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18280 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18281 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18282
18283 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18284 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18285 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18286 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18287 the server takes too long to respond.
18288
18289 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18290 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18291 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18292 long a time to respond.
18293
18294 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18295 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18296 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18297 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018298 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18299 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018300
18301 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18302 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18303 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18304 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18305 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018306 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018307 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18308 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18309 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18310 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18311 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18312 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18313 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18314 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018315 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018316 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18317 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18318 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018319
18320 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18321 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018322 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18323 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18324 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18325 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018326
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018327 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18328 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018330 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018331 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18332 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018333 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018334 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18335 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18336
18337 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18338 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18339 503 or 504 here.
18340
18341 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18342 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18343 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18344 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18345 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18346
18347 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18348 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018349 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018350 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18351 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18352
18353 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18354 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18355 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18356 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18357 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18358 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18359 between haproxy and the server.
18360
18361 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18362 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18363 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18364 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18365 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18366 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18367 solution is to fix the application.
18368
18369 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18370 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18371 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18372 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18373 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18374 external attacks.
18375
18376 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18377 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018378 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018379 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18380 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18381
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018382 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18383 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18384 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018385 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018386 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018387
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018388 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18389 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18390 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18391 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018392 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18393 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18394 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18395 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18396 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018397
18398 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18399 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18400 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18401 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18402
18403 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18404 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18405 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18406 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18407
18408 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18409 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18410 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18411 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018413The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18414persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18415important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18416re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18417
18418 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18419
18420 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18421 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18422 set on a GET request.
18423
18424 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18425 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018426 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018427 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18428
18429 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18430 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18431 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18432
18433 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18434 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18435 already got a cookie.
18436
18437 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18438 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18439 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18440 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18441 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18442
18443 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18444 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18445 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18446
18447 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18448 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18449 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18450
18451 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18452 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18453
18454 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18455 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18456 then advertised in the response.
18457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184598.6. Non-printable characters
18460-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018461
18462In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18463consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18464converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18465prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18466being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18467escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18468is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18469'}' when logging headers.
18470
18471Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18472issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18473containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18474
18475Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18476the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18477performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18478
18479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18481---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018482
18483Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18484achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018485section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018486cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18487the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18488the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018489locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018490not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18491user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18492a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18493wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18494
18495 Examples :
18496 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18497 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18498
18499 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18500 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18501
18502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18504---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018505
18506Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18507proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18508the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18509server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18510
18511Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18512response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018513section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018514
18515It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018516time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18517appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018518are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18519and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18520follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18521request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18522in the logs.
18523
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018524As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18525frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18526an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18527
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018528 Example :
18529 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18530 listen proxy-out
18531 mode http
18532 option httplog
18533 option logasap
18534 log global
18535 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18536
18537 # log the name of the virtual server
18538 capture request header Host len 20
18539
18540 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18541 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18542
18543 # log the beginning of the referrer
18544 capture request header Referer len 20
18545
18546 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18547 capture response header Server len 20
18548
18549 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18550 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018552 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18554
18555 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18556 capture response header Via len 20
18557
18558 # log the URL location during a redirection
18559 capture response header Location len 20
18560
18561 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18562 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18563 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18564 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18565 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18566
18567 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18568 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18569 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18570 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018571 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018572
18573 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18574 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18575 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18576 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18577 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018578 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018579
18580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185818.9. Examples of logs
18582---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018583
18584These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18585them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18586reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18587
18588 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18589 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18590 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18591
18592 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18593 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18594
18595 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18596 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18597 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18598
18599 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18600 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18601
18602 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18603 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18604 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18605
18606 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018607 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18609 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18610
18611 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18612 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18613 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18614
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018615 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18616 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18617 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18618 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18619 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18620 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018621
18622 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018623 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018624
18625 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18626 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18627 Nothing was sent to any server.
18628
18629 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18630 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18631
18632 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18633 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018634 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018635 send a 408 return code to the client.
18636
18637 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18638 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18639
18640 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18641 5 seconds ("c----").
18642
18643 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18644 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018645 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018646
18647 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018648 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018649 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18650 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18651 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18652 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18653 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018654
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018655
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200186569. Supported filters
18657--------------------
18658
18659Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18660accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18661unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18662
18663See also : "filter"
18664
186659.1. Trace
18666----------
18667
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018668filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018669
18670 Arguments:
18671 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18672 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18673
18674 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18675 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18676 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18677 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18678
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018679 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018680 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18681 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18682 amount of the parsed data.
18683
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018684 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018685
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018686This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18687callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18688information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18689filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18690
18691Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18692tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18693a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18694
18695
186969.2. HTTP compression
18697---------------------
18698
18699filter compression
18700
18701The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18702keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018703when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18704fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18705done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18706explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18707filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18708listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18709order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018710
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018711See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18712 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018713
18714
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200187159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18716--------------------------------------------
18717
18718filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18719
18720 Arguments :
18721
18722 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18723 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18724 parsed.
18725
18726 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18727 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18728 part must be placed in its own scope.
18729
18730The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18731external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018732streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018733exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18734also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18735
18736SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18737the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18738
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018739For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018740"doc/SPOE.txt".
18741
18742Important note:
18743 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18744 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18745
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100187469.4. Cache
18747----------
18748
18749filter cache <name>
18750
18751 Arguments :
18752
18753 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18754
18755The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18756"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018757cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018758other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18759case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18760is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18761filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018762listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18763order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018764
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018765See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18766 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18767
18768
187699.5. Fcgi-app
18770-------------
18771
18772filter fcg-app <name>
18773
18774 Arguments :
18775
18776 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18777
18778The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18779request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18780reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18781used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18782implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18783used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18784fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18785used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18786order.
18787
18788See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18789 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18790
18791
1879210. FastCGI applications
18793-------------------------
18794
18795HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18796feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18797the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18798FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18799servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18800FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18801backend.
18802
18803HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18804application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18805connection.
18806
1880710.1. Setup
18808-----------
18809
1881010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18811--------------------------
18812
18813fcgi-app <name>
18814 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18815 document root must be defined.
18816
18817acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18818 Declare or complete an access list.
18819
18820 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18821 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18822 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18823 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18824 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18825
18826docroot <path>
18827 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18828 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18829 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18830
18831index <script-name>
18832 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18833 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18834 is an optional setting.
18835
18836 Example :
18837 index index.php
18838
18839log-stderr global
18840log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18841 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18842 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18843
18844 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18845 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18846
18847pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18848 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18849 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18850 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18851
18852 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18853 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18854 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18855 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18856
18857 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18858 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18859
18860path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018861 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018862 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18863 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18864 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18865 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18866 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18867 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18868 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018869
18870 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018871 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018872 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18873 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18874 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18875 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018876
18877 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018878 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18879 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018880
18881option get-values
18882no option get-values
18883 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18884
18885 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18886 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18887
18888 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18889 application will accept.
18890
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018891 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18892 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018893
18894 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18895 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18896 option is disabled.
18897
18898 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18899 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18900 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18901 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18902 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18903 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18904
18905option keep-conn
18906no option keep-conn
18907 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18908 sending a response.
18909
18910 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18911 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18912
18913option max-reqs <reqs>
18914 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18915 accept.
18916
18917 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18918 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18919 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18920 to 1.
18921
18922option mpxs-conns
18923no option mpxs-conns
18924 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18925
18926 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18927 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18928
18929set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18930 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18931 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18932 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18933 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18934
18935 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18936 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18937 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18938
18939 Example :
18940 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18941 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18942
18943 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18944
18945
1894610.1.2. Proxy section
18947---------------------
18948
18949use-fcgi-app <name>
18950 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18951
18952 Arguments :
18953 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18954
18955 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18956 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18957 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18958 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18959 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18960
18961 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18962 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18963 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18964 application are evaluated.
18965
18966
1896710.1.3. Example
18968---------------
18969
18970 frontend front-http
18971 mode http
18972 bind *:80
18973 bind *:
18974
18975 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18976 default_backend back-static
18977
18978 backend back-static
18979 mode http
18980 server www A.B.C.D:80
18981
18982 backend back-dynamic
18983 mode http
18984 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18985 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18986
18987 fcgi-app php-fpm
18988 log-stderr global
18989 option keep-conn
18990
18991 docroot /var/www/my-app
18992 index index.php
18993 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18994
18995
1899610.2. Default parameters
18997------------------------
18998
18999A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19000the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019001script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019002applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19003
19004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19005 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19006 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19007 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19008 | | |
19009 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19010 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19011 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19012 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19013 | | application. |
19014 | | |
19015 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19016 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19017 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19018 | | |
19019 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19020 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19021 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19022 | | the application's configuration. |
19023 | | |
19024 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19025 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19026 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19027 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19028 | | |
19029 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19030 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19031 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19032 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19033 | | be defined. |
19034 | | |
19035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19036 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19037 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19038 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19039 | | is not set too. |
19040 | | |
19041 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19042 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19043 | | set. |
19044 | | |
19045 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19046 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19047 | | the request. |
19048 | | |
19049 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19050 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19051 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19052 | | |
19053 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19054 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19055 | | script to process the request. |
19056 | | |
19057 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19058 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19059 | | |
19060 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19061 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19062 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19063 | | |
19064 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19065 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19066 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19067 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19068 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19069 | | |
19070 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19071 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19072 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19073 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19074 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19075 | | side. |
19076 | | |
19077 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19078 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19079 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19080 | | connected to. |
19081 | | |
19082 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19083 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19084 | | |
19085 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19086 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19087 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19088 | | |
19089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19090
19091
1909210.3. Limitations
19093------------------
19094
19095The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19096way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19097during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19098establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19099application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19100or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19101message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19102these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19103and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19104
19105Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19106request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19107requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19108
19109About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19110into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19111fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19112"http-request" ones.
19113
19114Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19115FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19116processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19117must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19118here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019120/*
19121 * Local variables:
19122 * fill-column: 79
19123 * End:
19124 */